DESCRIPTION
This file contains the documentation of the perl public API generated by embed.pl, specifically a listing of functions, macros, flags, and variables that may be used by extension writers. At the end is a list of functions which have yet to be documented. The interfaces of those are subject to change without notice. Anything not listed here is not part of the public API, and should not be used by extension writers at all. For these reasons, blindly using functions listed in proto.h is to be avoided when writing extensions.Note that all Perl API global variables must be referenced with the "PL_" prefix. Again, those not listed here are not to be used by extension writers, and can be changed or removed without notice; same with macros. Some macros are provided for compatibility with the older, unadorned names, but this support may be disabled in a future release.
Perl was originally written to handle US-ASCII only (that is characters whose ordinal numbers are in the range 0 - 127). And documentation and comments may still use the term ASCII, when sometimes in fact the entire range from 0 - 255 is meant.
Note that Perl can be compiled and run under either ASCII or EBCDIC (See perlebcdic). Most of the documentation (and even comments in the code) ignore the EBCDIC possibility. For almost all purposes the differences are transparent. As an example, under EBCDIC, instead of UTF-8, UTF-EBCDIC is used to encode Unicode strings, and so whenever this documentation refers to "utf8" (and variants of that name, including in function names), it also (essentially transparently) means "UTF-EBCDIC". But the ordinals of characters differ between ASCII, EBCDIC, and the UTF- encodings, and a string encoded in UTF-EBCDIC may occupy more bytes than in UTF-8.
The listing below is alphabetical, case insensitive.
Gimme Values
- GIMME
-
A backward-compatible version of "GIMME_V" which can only return
"G_SCALAR" or "G_ARRAY"; in a void context, it returns "G_SCALAR".
Deprecated. Use "GIMME_V" instead.
U32 GIMME
- GIMME_V
-
The XSUB-writer's equivalent to Perl's "wantarray". Returns "G_VOID",
"G_SCALAR" or "G_ARRAY" for void, scalar or list context,
respectively. See perlcall for a usage example.
U32 GIMME_V
- G_ARRAY
- Used to indicate list context. See "GIMME_V", "GIMME" and perlcall.
- G_DISCARD
- Indicates that arguments returned from a callback should be discarded. See perlcall.
- G_EVAL
- Used to force a Perl "eval" wrapper around a callback. See perlcall.
- G_NOARGS
- Indicates that no arguments are being sent to a callback. See perlcall.
- G_SCALAR
- Used to indicate scalar context. See "GIMME_V", "GIMME", and perlcall.
- G_VOID
- Used to indicate void context. See "GIMME_V" and perlcall.
Array Manipulation Functions
- AvFILL
-
Same as "av_top_index()". Deprecated, use "av_top_index()" instead.
int AvFILL(AV* av)
- av_clear
-
Frees the all the elements of an array, leaving it empty.
The XS equivalent of "@array = ()". See also ``av_undef''.
Note that it is possible that the actions of a destructor called directly or indirectly by freeing an element of the array could cause the reference count of the array itself to be reduced (e.g. by deleting an entry in the symbol table). So it is a possibility that the AV could have been freed (or even reallocated) on return from the call unless you hold a reference to it.
void av_clear(AV *av)
- av_create_and_push
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Push an SV onto the end of the array, creating the array if necessary. A small internal helper function to remove a commonly duplicated idiom.
void av_create_and_push(AV **const avp, SV *const val)
- av_create_and_unshift_one
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Unshifts an SV onto the beginning of the array, creating the array if necessary. A small internal helper function to remove a commonly duplicated idiom.
SV** av_create_and_unshift_one(AV **const avp, SV *const val)
- av_delete
-
Deletes the element indexed by "key" from the array, makes the element mortal,
and returns it. If "flags" equals "G_DISCARD", the element is freed and null
is returned. Perl equivalent: "my $elem = delete($myarray[$idx]);" for the
non-"G_DISCARD" version and a void-context "delete($myarray[$idx]);" for the
"G_DISCARD" version.
SV* av_delete(AV *av, SSize_t key, I32 flags)
- av_exists
-
Returns true if the element indexed by "key" has been initialized.
This relies on the fact that uninitialized array elements are set to NULL.
Perl equivalent: "exists($myarray[$key])".
bool av_exists(AV *av, SSize_t key)
- av_extend
-
Pre-extend an array. The "key" is the index to which the array should be
extended.
void av_extend(AV *av, SSize_t key)
- av_fetch
-
Returns the SV at the specified index in the array. The "key" is the
index. If lval is true, you are guaranteed to get a real SV back (in case
it wasn't real before), which you can then modify. Check that the return
value is non-null before dereferencing it to a "SV*".
See ``Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays'' in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied arrays.
The rough perl equivalent is $myarray[$idx].
SV** av_fetch(AV *av, SSize_t key, I32 lval)
- av_fill
-
Set the highest index in the array to the given number, equivalent to
Perl's "$#array = $fill;".
The number of elements in the array will be "fill + 1" after av_fill() returns. If the array was previously shorter, then the additional elements appended are set to NULL. If the array was longer, then the excess elements are freed. "av_fill(av, -1)" is the same as "av_clear(av)".
void av_fill(AV *av, SSize_t fill)
- av_len
-
Same as ``av_top_index''. Note that, unlike what the name implies, it returns
the highest index in the array, so to get the size of the array you need to use
"av_len(av) + 1". This is unlike ``sv_len'', which returns what you would
expect.
SSize_t av_len(AV *av)
- av_make
-
Creates a new AV and populates it with a list of SVs. The SVs are copied
into the array, so they may be freed after the call to av_make. The new AV
will have a reference count of 1.
Perl equivalent: "my @new_array = ($scalar1, $scalar2, $scalar3...);"
AV* av_make(SSize_t size, SV **strp)
- av_pop
-
Removes one SV from the end of the array, reducing its size by one and
returning the SV (transferring control of one reference count) to the
caller. Returns &PL_sv_undef if the array is empty.
Perl equivalent: "pop(@myarray);"
SV* av_pop(AV *av)
- av_push
-
Pushes an SV onto the end of the array. The array will grow automatically
to accommodate the addition. This takes ownership of one reference count.
Perl equivalent: "push @myarray, $elem;".
void av_push(AV *av, SV *val)
- av_shift
-
Removes one SV from the start of the array, reducing its size by one and
returning the SV (transferring control of one reference count) to the
caller. Returns &PL_sv_undef if the array is empty.
Perl equivalent: "shift(@myarray);"
SV* av_shift(AV *av)
- av_store
-
Stores an SV in an array. The array index is specified as "key". The
return value will be NULL if the operation failed or if the value did not
need to be actually stored within the array (as in the case of tied
arrays). Otherwise, it can be dereferenced
to get the "SV*" that was stored
there (= "val")).
Note that the caller is responsible for suitably incrementing the reference count of "val" before the call, and decrementing it if the function returned NULL.
Approximate Perl equivalent: "$myarray[$key] = $val;".
See ``Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays'' in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied arrays.
SV** av_store(AV *av, SSize_t key, SV *val)
- av_tindex
-
Same as "av_top_index()".
int av_tindex(AV* av)
- av_top_index
-
Returns the highest index in the array. The number of elements in the
array is "av_top_index(av) + 1". Returns -1 if the array is empty.
The Perl equivalent for this is $#myarray.
(A slightly shorter form is "av_tindex".)
SSize_t av_top_index(AV *av)
- av_undef
-
Undefines the array. The XS equivalent of "undef(@array)".
As well as freeing all the elements of the array (like "av_clear()"), this also frees the memory used by the av to store its list of scalars.
See ``av_clear'' for a note about the array possibly being invalid on return.
void av_undef(AV *av)
- av_unshift
-
Unshift the given number of "undef" values onto the beginning of the
array. The array will grow automatically to accommodate the addition. You
must then use "av_store" to assign values to these new elements.
Perl equivalent: "unshift @myarray, ( (undef) x $n );"
void av_unshift(AV *av, SSize_t num)
- get_av
-
Returns the AV of the specified Perl global or package array with the given
name (so it won't work on lexical variables). "flags" are passed
to "gv_fetchpv". If "GV_ADD" is set and the
Perl variable does not exist then it will be created. If "flags" is zero
and the variable does not exist then NULL is returned.
Perl equivalent: "@{"$name"}".
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
AV* get_av(const char *name, I32 flags)
- newAV
-
Creates a new AV. The reference count is set to 1.
Perl equivalent: "my @array;".
AV* newAV()
- sortsv
-
Sort an array. Here is an example:
sortsv(AvARRAY(av), av_top_index(av)+1, Perl_sv_cmp_locale);
Currently this always uses mergesort. See sortsv_flags for a more flexible routine.
void sortsv(SV** array, size_t num_elts, SVCOMPARE_t cmp)
- sortsv_flags
-
Sort an array, with various options.
void sortsv_flags(SV** array, size_t num_elts, SVCOMPARE_t cmp, U32 flags)
xsubpp variables and internal functions
- ax
-
Variable which is setup by "xsubpp" to indicate the stack base offset,
used by the "ST", "XSprePUSH" and "XSRETURN" macros. The "dMARK" macro
must be called prior to setup the "MARK" variable.
I32 ax
- CLASS
-
Variable which is setup by "xsubpp" to indicate the
class name for a C++ XS constructor. This is always a "char*". See "THIS".
char* CLASS
- dAX
-
Sets up the "ax" variable.
This is usually handled automatically by "xsubpp" by calling "dXSARGS".
dAX;
- dAXMARK
-
Sets up the "ax" variable and stack marker variable "mark".
This is usually handled automatically by "xsubpp" by calling "dXSARGS".
dAXMARK;
- dITEMS
-
Sets up the "items" variable.
This is usually handled automatically by "xsubpp" by calling "dXSARGS".
dITEMS;
- dUNDERBAR
-
Sets up any variable needed by the "UNDERBAR" macro. It used to define
"padoff_du", but it is currently a noop. However, it is strongly advised
to still use it for ensuring past and future compatibility.
dUNDERBAR;
- dXSARGS
-
Sets up stack and mark pointers for an XSUB, calling dSP and dMARK.
Sets up the "ax" and "items" variables by calling "dAX" and "dITEMS".
This is usually handled automatically by "xsubpp".
dXSARGS;
- dXSI32
-
Sets up the "ix" variable for an XSUB which has aliases. This is usually
handled automatically by "xsubpp".
dXSI32;
- items
-
Variable which is setup by "xsubpp" to indicate the number of
items on the stack. See ``Variable-length Parameter Lists'' in perlxs.
I32 items
- ix
-
Variable which is setup by "xsubpp" to indicate which of an
XSUB's aliases was used to invoke it. See ``The ALIAS: Keyword'' in perlxs.
I32 ix
- RETVAL
-
Variable which is setup by "xsubpp" to hold the return value for an
XSUB. This is always the proper type for the XSUB. See
``The RETVAL Variable'' in perlxs.
(whatever) RETVAL
- ST
-
Used to access elements on the XSUB's stack.
SV* ST(int ix)
- THIS
-
Variable which is setup by "xsubpp" to designate the object in a C++
XSUB. This is always the proper type for the C++ object. See "CLASS" and
``Using XS With C++'' in perlxs.
(whatever) THIS
- UNDERBAR
- The SV* corresponding to the $_ variable. Works even if there is a lexical $_ in scope.
- XS
- Macro to declare an XSUB and its C parameter list. This is handled by "xsubpp". It is the same as using the more explicit XS_EXTERNAL macro.
- XS_EXTERNAL
- Macro to declare an XSUB and its C parameter list explicitly exporting the symbols.
- XS_INTERNAL
- Macro to declare an XSUB and its C parameter list without exporting the symbols. This is handled by "xsubpp" and generally preferable over exporting the XSUB symbols unnecessarily.
Callback Functions
- call_argv
-
Performs a callback to the specified named and package-scoped Perl subroutine
with "argv" (a NULL-terminated array of strings) as arguments. See
perlcall.
Approximate Perl equivalent: "&{"$sub_name"}(@$argv)".
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 call_argv(const char* sub_name, I32 flags, char** argv)
- call_method
-
Performs a callback to the specified Perl method. The blessed object must
be on the stack. See perlcall.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 call_method(const char* methname, I32 flags)
- call_pv
-
Performs a callback to the specified Perl sub. See perlcall.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 call_pv(const char* sub_name, I32 flags)
- call_sv
-
Performs a callback to the Perl sub specified by the SV.
If neither the "G_METHOD" or "G_METHOD_NAMED" flag is supplied, the SV may be any of a CV, a GV, a reference to a CV, a reference to a GV or "SvPV(sv)" will be used as the name of the sub to call.
If the "G_METHOD" flag is supplied, the SV may be a reference to a CV or "SvPV(sv)" will be used as the name of the method to call.
If the "G_METHOD_NAMED" flag is supplied, "SvPV(sv)" will be used as the name of the method to call.
Some other values are treated specially for internal use and should not be depended on.
See perlcall.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 call_sv(SV* sv, VOL I32 flags)
- ENTER
-
Opening bracket on a callback. See "LEAVE" and perlcall.
ENTER;
- eval_pv
-
Tells Perl to "eval" the given string in scalar context and return an SV* result.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* eval_pv(const char* p, I32 croak_on_error)
- eval_sv
-
Tells Perl to "eval" the string in the SV. It supports the same flags
as "call_sv", with the obvious exception of G_EVAL. See perlcall.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 eval_sv(SV* sv, I32 flags)
- FREETMPS
-
Closing bracket for temporaries on a callback. See "SAVETMPS" and
perlcall.
FREETMPS;
- LEAVE
-
Closing bracket on a callback. See "ENTER" and perlcall.
LEAVE;
- SAVETMPS
-
Opening bracket for temporaries on a callback. See "FREETMPS" and
perlcall.
SAVETMPS;
Character case changing
- toFOLD
-
Converts the specified character to foldcase. If the input is anything but an
ASCII uppercase character, that input character itself is returned. Variant
"toFOLD_A" is equivalent. (There is no equivalent "to_FOLD_L1" for the full
Latin1 range, as the full generality of ``toFOLD_uni'' is needed there.)
U8 toFOLD(U8 ch)
- toFOLD_uni
-
Converts the Unicode code point "cp" to its foldcase version, and
stores that in UTF-8 in "s", and its length in bytes in "lenp". Note
that the buffer pointed to by "s" needs to be at least "UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1"
bytes since the foldcase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the foldcased version is returned (but note, as explained just above, that there may be more.)
UV toFOLD_uni(UV cp, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
- toFOLD_utf8
-
Converts the UTF-8 encoded character at "p" to its foldcase version, and
stores that in UTF-8 in "s", and its length in bytes in "lenp". Note
that the buffer pointed to by "s" needs to be at least "UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1"
bytes since the foldcase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the foldcased version is returned (but note, as explained just above, that there may be more.)
The input character at "p" is assumed to be well-formed.
UV toFOLD_utf8(U8* p, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
- toLOWER
-
Converts the specified character to lowercase. If the input is anything but an
ASCII uppercase character, that input character itself is returned. Variant
"toLOWER_A" is equivalent.
U8 toLOWER(U8 ch)
- toLOWER_L1
-
Converts the specified Latin1 character to lowercase. The results are undefined if
the input doesn't fit in a byte.
U8 toLOWER_L1(U8 ch)
- toLOWER_LC
-
Converts the specified character to lowercase using the current locale's rules,
if possible; otherwise returns the input character itself.
U8 toLOWER_LC(U8 ch)
- toLOWER_uni
-
Converts the Unicode code point "cp" to its lowercase version, and
stores that in UTF-8 in "s", and its length in bytes in "lenp". Note
that the buffer pointed to by "s" needs to be at least "UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1"
bytes since the lowercase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the lowercased version is returned (but note, as explained just above, that there may be more.)
UV toLOWER_uni(UV cp, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
- toLOWER_utf8
-
Converts the UTF-8 encoded character at "p" to its lowercase version, and
stores that in UTF-8 in "s", and its length in bytes in "lenp". Note
that the buffer pointed to by "s" needs to be at least "UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1"
bytes since the lowercase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the lowercased version is returned (but note, as explained just above, that there may be more.)
The input character at "p" is assumed to be well-formed.
UV toLOWER_utf8(U8* p, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
- toTITLE
-
Converts the specified character to titlecase. If the input is anything but an
ASCII lowercase character, that input character itself is returned. Variant
"toTITLE_A" is equivalent. (There is no "toTITLE_L1" for the full Latin1 range,
as the full generality of ``toTITLE_uni'' is needed there. Titlecase is not a
concept used in locale handling, so there is no functionality for that.)
U8 toTITLE(U8 ch)
- toTITLE_uni
-
Converts the Unicode code point "cp" to its titlecase version, and
stores that in UTF-8 in "s", and its length in bytes in "lenp". Note
that the buffer pointed to by "s" needs to be at least "UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1"
bytes since the titlecase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the titlecased version is returned (but note, as explained just above, that there may be more.)
UV toTITLE_uni(UV cp, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
- toTITLE_utf8
-
Converts the UTF-8 encoded character at "p" to its titlecase version, and
stores that in UTF-8 in "s", and its length in bytes in "lenp". Note
that the buffer pointed to by "s" needs to be at least "UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1"
bytes since the titlecase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the titlecased version is returned (but note, as explained just above, that there may be more.)
The input character at "p" is assumed to be well-formed.
UV toTITLE_utf8(U8* p, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
- toUPPER
-
Converts the specified character to uppercase. If the input is anything but an
ASCII lowercase character, that input character itself is returned. Variant
"toUPPER_A" is equivalent.
U8 toUPPER(U8 ch)
- toUPPER_uni
-
Converts the Unicode code point "cp" to its uppercase version, and
stores that in UTF-8 in "s", and its length in bytes in "lenp". Note
that the buffer pointed to by "s" needs to be at least "UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1"
bytes since the uppercase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the uppercased version is returned (but note, as explained just above, that there may be more.)
UV toUPPER_uni(UV cp, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
- toUPPER_utf8
-
Converts the UTF-8 encoded character at "p" to its uppercase version, and
stores that in UTF-8 in "s", and its length in bytes in "lenp". Note
that the buffer pointed to by "s" needs to be at least "UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1"
bytes since the uppercase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the uppercased version is returned (but note, as explained just above, that there may be more.)
The input character at "p" is assumed to be well-formed.
UV toUPPER_utf8(U8* p, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
Character classification
This section is about functions (really macros) that classify characters into types, such as punctuation versus alphabetic, etc. Most of these are analogous to regular expression character classes. (See ``POSIX Character Classes'' in perlrecharclass.) There are several variants for each class. (Not all macros have all variants; each item below lists the ones valid for it.) None are affected by "use bytes", and only the ones with "LC" in the name are affected by the current locale.The base function, e.g., "isALPHA()", takes an octet (either a "char" or a "U8") as input and returns a boolean as to whether or not the character represented by that octet is (or on non-ASCII platforms, corresponds to) an ASCII character in the named class based on platform, Unicode, and Perl rules. If the input is a number that doesn't fit in an octet, FALSE is returned.
Variant "isFOO_A" (e.g., "isALPHA_A()") is identical to the base function with no suffix "_A".
Variant "isFOO_L1" imposes the Latin-1 (or EBCDIC equivlalent) character set onto the platform. That is, the code points that are ASCII are unaffected, since ASCII is a subset of Latin-1. But the non-ASCII code points are treated as if they are Latin-1 characters. For example, "isWORDCHAR_L1()" will return true when called with the code point 0xDF, which is a word character in both ASCII and EBCDIC (though it represents different characters in each).
Variant "isFOO_uni" is like the "isFOO_L1" variant, but accepts any UV code point as input. If the code point is larger than 255, Unicode rules are used to determine if it is in the character class. For example, "isWORDCHAR_uni(0x100)" returns TRUE, since 0x100 is LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A WITH MACRON in Unicode, and is a word character.
Variant "isFOO_utf8" is like "isFOO_uni", but the input is a pointer to a (known to be well-formed) UTF-8 encoded string ("U8*" or "char*"). The classification of just the first (possibly multi-byte) character in the string is tested.
Variant "isFOO_LC" is like the "isFOO_A" and "isFOO_L1" variants, but the result is based on the current locale, which is what "LC" in the name stands for. If Perl can determine that the current locale is a UTF-8 locale, it uses the published Unicode rules; otherwise, it uses the C library function that gives the named classification. For example, "isDIGIT_LC()" when not in a UTF-8 locale returns the result of calling "isdigit()". FALSE is always returned if the input won't fit into an octet. On some platforms where the C library function is known to be defective, Perl changes its result to follow the POSIX standard's rules.
Variant "isFOO_LC_uvchr" is like "isFOO_LC", but is defined on any UV. It returns the same as "isFOO_LC" for input code points less than 256, and returns the hard-coded, not-affected-by-locale, Unicode results for larger ones.
Variant "isFOO_LC_utf8" is like "isFOO_LC_uvchr", but the input is a pointer to a (known to be well-formed) UTF-8 encoded string ("U8*" or "char*"). The classification of just the first (possibly multi-byte) character in the string is tested.
- isALPHA
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is an
alphabetic character, analogous to "m/[[:alpha:]]/".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isALPHA_A", "isALPHA_L1", "isALPHA_uni", "isALPHA_utf8", "isALPHA_LC",
"isALPHA_LC_uvchr", and "isALPHA_LC_utf8".
bool isALPHA(char ch)
- isALPHANUMERIC
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a either an
alphabetic character or decimal digit, analogous to "m/[[:alnum:]]/".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isALPHANUMERIC_A", "isALPHANUMERIC_L1", "isALPHANUMERIC_uni",
"isALPHANUMERIC_utf8", "isALPHANUMERIC_LC", "isALPHANUMERIC_LC_uvchr", and
"isALPHANUMERIC_LC_utf8".
bool isALPHANUMERIC(char ch)
- isASCII
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is one of the 128
characters in the ASCII character set, analogous to "m/[[:ascii:]]/".
On non-ASCII platforms, it returns TRUE iff this
character corresponds to an ASCII character. Variants "isASCII_A()" and
"isASCII_L1()" are identical to "isASCII()".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isASCII_uni", "isASCII_utf8", "isASCII_LC", "isASCII_LC_uvchr", and
"isASCII_LC_utf8". Note, however, that some platforms do not have the C
library routine "isascii()". In these cases, the variants whose names contain
"LC" are the same as the corresponding ones without.
Also note, that because all ASCII characters are UTF-8 invariant (meaning they have the exact same representation (always a single byte) whether encoded in UTF-8 or not), "isASCII" will give the correct results when called with any byte in any string encoded or not in UTF-8. And similarly "isASCII_utf8" will work properly on any string encoded or not in UTF-8.
bool isASCII(char ch)
- isBLANK
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a
character considered to be a blank, analogous to "m/[[:blank:]]/".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isBLANK_A", "isBLANK_L1", "isBLANK_uni", "isBLANK_utf8", "isBLANK_LC",
"isBLANK_LC_uvchr", and "isBLANK_LC_utf8". Note, however, that some
platforms do not have the C library routine "isblank()". In these cases, the
variants whose names contain "LC" are the same as the corresponding ones
without.
bool isBLANK(char ch)
- isCNTRL
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a
control character, analogous to "m/[[:cntrl:]]/".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isCNTRL_A", "isCNTRL_L1", "isCNTRL_uni", "isCNTRL_utf8", "isCNTRL_LC",
"isCNTRL_LC_uvchr", and "isCNTRL_LC_utf8"
On EBCDIC platforms, you almost always want to use the "isCNTRL_L1" variant.
bool isCNTRL(char ch)
- isDIGIT
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a
digit, analogous to "m/[[:digit:]]/".
Variants "isDIGIT_A" and "isDIGIT_L1" are identical to "isDIGIT".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isDIGIT_uni", "isDIGIT_utf8", "isDIGIT_LC", "isDIGIT_LC_uvchr", and
"isDIGIT_LC_utf8".
bool isDIGIT(char ch)
- isGRAPH
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a
graphic character, analogous to "m/[[:graph:]]/".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isGRAPH_A", "isGRAPH_L1", "isGRAPH_uni", "isGRAPH_utf8", "isGRAPH_LC",
"isGRAPH_LC_uvchr", and "isGRAPH_LC_utf8".
bool isGRAPH(char ch)
- isIDCONT
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character can be the
second or succeeding character of an identifier. This is very close to, but
not quite the same as the official Unicode property "XID_Continue". The
difference is that this returns true only if the input character also matches
``isWORDCHAR''. See the top of this section for
an
explanation of variants "isIDCONT_A", "isIDCONT_L1", "isIDCONT_uni",
"isIDCONT_utf8", "isIDCONT_LC", "isIDCONT_LC_uvchr", and
"isIDCONT_LC_utf8".
bool isIDCONT(char ch)
- isIDFIRST
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character can be the first
character of an identifier. This is very close to, but not quite the same as
the official Unicode property "XID_Start". The difference is that this
returns true only if the input character also matches ``isWORDCHAR''.
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isIDFIRST_A", "isIDFIRST_L1", "isIDFIRST_uni", "isIDFIRST_utf8",
"isIDFIRST_LC", "isIDFIRST_LC_uvchr", and "isIDFIRST_LC_utf8".
bool isIDFIRST(char ch)
- isLOWER
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a
lowercase character, analogous to "m/[[:lower:]]/".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isLOWER_A", "isLOWER_L1", "isLOWER_uni", "isLOWER_utf8", "isLOWER_LC",
"isLOWER_LC_uvchr", and "isLOWER_LC_utf8".
bool isLOWER(char ch)
- isOCTAL
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is an
octal digit, [0-7].
The only two variants are "isOCTAL_A" and "isOCTAL_L1"; each is identical to
"isOCTAL".
bool isOCTAL(char ch)
- isPRINT
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a
printable character, analogous to "m/[[:print:]]/".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isPRINT_A", "isPRINT_L1", "isPRINT_uni", "isPRINT_utf8", "isPRINT_LC",
"isPRINT_LC_uvchr", and "isPRINT_LC_utf8".
bool isPRINT(char ch)
- isPSXSPC
-
(short for Posix Space)
Starting in 5.18, this is identical in all its forms to the
corresponding "isSPACE()" macros.
The locale forms of this macro are identical to their corresponding
"isSPACE()" forms in all Perl releases. In releases prior to 5.18, the
non-locale forms differ from their "isSPACE()" forms only in that the
"isSPACE()" forms don't match a Vertical Tab, and the "isPSXSPC()" forms do.
Otherwise they are identical. Thus this macro is analogous to what
"m/[[:space:]]/" matches in a regular expression.
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isPSXSPC_A", "isPSXSPC_L1", "isPSXSPC_uni", "isPSXSPC_utf8", "isPSXSPC_LC",
"isPSXSPC_LC_uvchr", and "isPSXSPC_LC_utf8".
bool isPSXSPC(char ch)
- isPUNCT
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a
punctuation character, analogous to "m/[[:punct:]]/".
Note that the definition of what is punctuation isn't as
straightforward as one might desire. See ``POSIX Character
Classes'' in perlrecharclass for details.
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isPUNCT_A", "isPUNCT_L1", "isPUNCT_uni", "isPUNCT_utf8", "isPUNCT_LC",
"isPUNCT_LC_uvchr", and "isPUNCT_LC_utf8".
bool isPUNCT(char ch)
- isSPACE
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a
whitespace character. This is analogous
to what "m/\s/" matches in a regular expression. Starting in Perl 5.18
this also matches what "m/[[:space:]]/" does. Prior to 5.18, only the
locale forms of this macro (the ones with "LC" in their names) matched
precisely what "m/[[:space:]]/" does. In those releases, the only difference,
in the non-locale variants, was that "isSPACE()" did not match a vertical tab.
(See ``isPSXSPC'' for a macro that matches a vertical tab in all releases.)
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isSPACE_A", "isSPACE_L1", "isSPACE_uni", "isSPACE_utf8", "isSPACE_LC",
"isSPACE_LC_uvchr", and "isSPACE_LC_utf8".
bool isSPACE(char ch)
- isUPPER
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is an
uppercase character, analogous to "m/[[:upper:]]/".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isUPPER_A", "isUPPER_L1", "isUPPER_uni", "isUPPER_utf8", "isUPPER_LC",
"isUPPER_LC_uvchr", and "isUPPER_LC_utf8".
bool isUPPER(char ch)
- isWORDCHAR
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a character
that is a word character, analogous to what "m/\w/" and "m/[[:word:]]/" match
in a regular expression. A word character is an alphabetic character, a
decimal digit, a connecting punctuation character (such as an underscore), or
a ``mark'' character that attaches to one of those (like some sort of accent).
"isALNUM()" is a synonym provided for backward compatibility, even though a
word character includes more than the standard C language meaning of
alphanumeric.
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isWORDCHAR_A", "isWORDCHAR_L1", "isWORDCHAR_uni", and "isWORDCHAR_utf8".
"isWORDCHAR_LC", "isWORDCHAR_LC_uvchr", and "isWORDCHAR_LC_utf8" are also as
described there, but additionally include the platform's native underscore.
bool isWORDCHAR(char ch)
- isXDIGIT
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a hexadecimal
digit. In the ASCII range these are "[0-9A-Fa-f]". Variants "isXDIGIT_A()"
and "isXDIGIT_L1()" are identical to "isXDIGIT()".
See the top of this section for an explanation of
variants
"isXDIGIT_uni", "isXDIGIT_utf8", "isXDIGIT_LC", "isXDIGIT_LC_uvchr", and
"isXDIGIT_LC_utf8".
bool isXDIGIT(char ch)
Cloning an interpreter
- perl_clone
-
Create and return a new interpreter by cloning the current one.
perl_clone takes these flags as parameters:
CLONEf_COPY_STACKS - is used to, well, copy the stacks also, without it we only clone the data and zero the stacks, with it we copy the stacks and the new perl interpreter is ready to run at the exact same point as the previous one. The pseudo-fork code uses COPY_STACKS while the threads->create doesn't.
CLONEf_KEEP_PTR_TABLE - perl_clone keeps a ptr_table with the pointer of the old variable as a key and the new variable as a value, this allows it to check if something has been cloned and not clone it again but rather just use the value and increase the refcount. If KEEP_PTR_TABLE is not set then perl_clone will kill the ptr_table using the function "ptr_table_free(PL_ptr_table); PL_ptr_table = NULL;", reason to keep it around is if you want to dup some of your own variable who are outside the graph perl scans, example of this code is in threads.xs create.
CLONEf_CLONE_HOST - This is a win32 thing, it is ignored on unix, it tells perls win32host code (which is c++) to clone itself, this is needed on win32 if you want to run two threads at the same time, if you just want to do some stuff in a separate perl interpreter and then throw it away and return to the original one, you don't need to do anything.
PerlInterpreter* perl_clone( PerlInterpreter *proto_perl, UV flags )
Compile-time scope hooks
- BhkDISABLE
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Temporarily disable an entry in this BHK structure, by clearing the appropriate flag. which is a preprocessor token indicating which entry to disable.
void BhkDISABLE(BHK *hk, which)
- BhkENABLE
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Re-enable an entry in this BHK structure, by setting the appropriate flag. which is a preprocessor token indicating which entry to enable. This will assert (under -DDEBUGGING) if the entry doesn't contain a valid pointer.
void BhkENABLE(BHK *hk, which)
- BhkENTRY_set
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Set an entry in the BHK structure, and set the flags to indicate it is valid. which is a preprocessing token indicating which entry to set. The type of ptr depends on the entry.
void BhkENTRY_set(BHK *hk, which, void *ptr)
- blockhook_register
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Register a set of hooks to be called when the Perl lexical scope changes at compile time. See ``Compile-time scope hooks'' in perlguts.
NOTE: this function must be explicitly called as Perl_blockhook_register with an aTHX_ parameter.
void Perl_blockhook_register(pTHX_ BHK *hk)
COP Hint Hashes
- cophh_2hv
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Generates and returns a standard Perl hash representing the full set of key/value pairs in the cop hints hash cophh. flags is currently unused and must be zero.
HV * cophh_2hv(const COPHH *cophh, U32 flags)
- cophh_copy
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Make and return a complete copy of the cop hints hash cophh.
COPHH * cophh_copy(COPHH *cophh)
- cophh_delete_pv
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``cophh_delete_pvn'', but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
COPHH * cophh_delete_pv(const COPHH *cophh, const char *key, U32 hash, U32 flags)
- cophh_delete_pvn
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Delete a key and its associated value from the cop hints hash cophh, and returns the modified hash. The returned hash pointer is in general not the same as the hash pointer that was passed in. The input hash is consumed by the function, and the pointer to it must not be subsequently used. Use ``cophh_copy'' if you need both hashes.
The key is specified by keypv and keylen. If flags has the "COPHH_KEY_UTF8" bit set, the key octets are interpreted as UTF-8, otherwise they are interpreted as Latin-1. hash is a precomputed hash of the key string, or zero if it has not been precomputed.
COPHH * cophh_delete_pvn(COPHH *cophh, const char *keypv, STRLEN keylen, U32 hash, U32 flags)
- cophh_delete_pvs
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``cophh_delete_pvn'', but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair, and no precomputed hash.
COPHH * cophh_delete_pvs(const COPHH *cophh, const char *key, U32 flags)
- cophh_delete_sv
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``cophh_delete_pvn'', but takes a Perl scalar instead of a string/length pair.
COPHH * cophh_delete_sv(const COPHH *cophh, SV *key, U32 hash, U32 flags)
- cophh_fetch_pv
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``cophh_fetch_pvn'', but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
SV * cophh_fetch_pv(const COPHH *cophh, const char *key, U32 hash, U32 flags)
- cophh_fetch_pvn
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Look up the entry in the cop hints hash cophh with the key specified by keypv and keylen. If flags has the "COPHH_KEY_UTF8" bit set, the key octets are interpreted as UTF-8, otherwise they are interpreted as Latin-1. hash is a precomputed hash of the key string, or zero if it has not been precomputed. Returns a mortal scalar copy of the value associated with the key, or &PL_sv_placeholder if there is no value associated with the key.
SV * cophh_fetch_pvn(const COPHH *cophh, const char *keypv, STRLEN keylen, U32 hash, U32 flags)
- cophh_fetch_pvs
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``cophh_fetch_pvn'', but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair, and no precomputed hash.
SV * cophh_fetch_pvs(const COPHH *cophh, const char *key, U32 flags)
- cophh_fetch_sv
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``cophh_fetch_pvn'', but takes a Perl scalar instead of a string/length pair.
SV * cophh_fetch_sv(const COPHH *cophh, SV *key, U32 hash, U32 flags)
- cophh_free
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Discard the cop hints hash cophh, freeing all resources associated with it.
void cophh_free(COPHH *cophh)
- cophh_new_empty
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Generate and return a fresh cop hints hash containing no entries.
COPHH * cophh_new_empty()
- cophh_store_pv
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``cophh_store_pvn'', but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
COPHH * cophh_store_pv(const COPHH *cophh, const char *key, U32 hash, SV *value, U32 flags)
- cophh_store_pvn
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Stores a value, associated with a key, in the cop hints hash cophh, and returns the modified hash. The returned hash pointer is in general not the same as the hash pointer that was passed in. The input hash is consumed by the function, and the pointer to it must not be subsequently used. Use ``cophh_copy'' if you need both hashes.
The key is specified by keypv and keylen. If flags has the "COPHH_KEY_UTF8" bit set, the key octets are interpreted as UTF-8, otherwise they are interpreted as Latin-1. hash is a precomputed hash of the key string, or zero if it has not been precomputed.
value is the scalar value to store for this key. value is copied by this function, which thus does not take ownership of any reference to it, and later changes to the scalar will not be reflected in the value visible in the cop hints hash. Complex types of scalar will not be stored with referential integrity, but will be coerced to strings.
COPHH * cophh_store_pvn(COPHH *cophh, const char *keypv, STRLEN keylen, U32 hash, SV *value, U32 flags)
- cophh_store_pvs
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``cophh_store_pvn'', but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair, and no precomputed hash.
COPHH * cophh_store_pvs(const COPHH *cophh, const char *key, SV *value, U32 flags)
- cophh_store_sv
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``cophh_store_pvn'', but takes a Perl scalar instead of a string/length pair.
COPHH * cophh_store_sv(const COPHH *cophh, SV *key, U32 hash, SV *value, U32 flags)
COP Hint Reading
- cop_hints_2hv
-
Generates and returns a standard Perl hash representing the full set of
hint entries in the cop cop. flags is currently unused and must
be zero.
HV * cop_hints_2hv(const COP *cop, U32 flags)
- cop_hints_fetch_pv
-
Like ``cop_hints_fetch_pvn'', but takes a nul-terminated string instead
of a string/length pair.
SV * cop_hints_fetch_pv(const COP *cop, const char *key, U32 hash, U32 flags)
- cop_hints_fetch_pvn
-
Look up the hint entry in the cop cop with the key specified by
keypv and keylen. If flags has the "COPHH_KEY_UTF8" bit set,
the key octets are interpreted as UTF-8, otherwise they are interpreted
as Latin-1. hash is a precomputed hash of the key string, or zero if
it has not been precomputed. Returns a mortal scalar copy of the value
associated with the key, or &PL_sv_placeholder if there is no value
associated with the key.
SV * cop_hints_fetch_pvn(const COP *cop, const char *keypv, STRLEN keylen, U32 hash, U32 flags)
- cop_hints_fetch_pvs
-
Like ``cop_hints_fetch_pvn'', but takes a literal string instead of a
string/length pair, and no precomputed hash.
SV * cop_hints_fetch_pvs(const COP *cop, const char *key, U32 flags)
- cop_hints_fetch_sv
-
Like ``cop_hints_fetch_pvn'', but takes a Perl scalar instead of a
string/length pair.
SV * cop_hints_fetch_sv(const COP *cop, SV *key, U32 hash, U32 flags)
Custom Operators
- custom_op_register
-
Register a custom op. See ``Custom Operators'' in perlguts.
NOTE: this function must be explicitly called as Perl_custom_op_register with an aTHX_ parameter.
void Perl_custom_op_register(pTHX_ Perl_ppaddr_t ppaddr, const XOP *xop)
- custom_op_xop
-
Return the XOP structure for a given custom op. This macro should be
considered internal to OP_NAME and the other access macros: use them instead.
This macro does call a function. Prior
to 5.19.6, this was implemented as a
function.
NOTE: this function must be explicitly called as Perl_custom_op_xop with an aTHX_ parameter.
const XOP * Perl_custom_op_xop(pTHX_ const OP *o)
- XopDISABLE
-
Temporarily disable a member of the XOP, by clearing the appropriate flag.
void XopDISABLE(XOP *xop, which)
- XopENABLE
-
Reenable a member of the XOP which has been disabled.
void XopENABLE(XOP *xop, which)
- XopENTRY
-
Return a member of the XOP structure. which is a cpp token
indicating which entry to return. If the member is not set
this will return a default value. The return type depends
on which. This macro evaluates its arguments more than
once. If you are using "Perl_custom_op_xop" to retreive a
"XOP *" from a "OP *", use the more efficient ``XopENTRYCUSTOM'' instead.
XopENTRY(XOP *xop, which)
- XopENTRYCUSTOM
-
Exactly like "XopENTRY(XopENTRY(Perl_custom_op_xop(aTHX_ o), which)" but more
efficient. The which parameter is identical to ``XopENTRY''.
XopENTRYCUSTOM(const OP *o, which)
- XopENTRY_set
-
Set a member of the XOP structure. which is a cpp token
indicating which entry to set. See ``Custom Operators'' in perlguts
for details about the available members and how
they are used. This macro evaluates its argument
more than once.
void XopENTRY_set(XOP *xop, which, value)
- XopFLAGS
-
Return the XOP's flags.
U32 XopFLAGS(XOP *xop)
CV Manipulation Functions
This section documents functions to manipulate CVs which are code-values, or subroutines. For more information, see perlguts.- caller_cx
-
The XSUB-writer's equivalent of caller(). The
returned "PERL_CONTEXT" structure can be interrogated to find all the
information returned to Perl by "caller". Note that XSUBs don't get a
stack frame, so "caller_cx(0, NULL)" will return information for the
immediately-surrounding Perl code.
This function skips over the automatic calls to &DB::sub made on the behalf of the debugger. If the stack frame requested was a sub called by "DB::sub", the return value will be the frame for the call to "DB::sub", since that has the correct line number/etc. for the call site. If dbcxp is non-"NULL", it will be set to a pointer to the frame for the sub call itself.
const PERL_CONTEXT * caller_cx( I32 level, const PERL_CONTEXT **dbcxp )
- CvSTASH
-
Returns the stash of the CV. A stash is the symbol table hash, containing
the package-scoped variables in the package where the subroutine was defined.
For more information, see perlguts.
This also has a special use with XS AUTOLOAD subs. See ``Autoloading with XSUBs'' in perlguts.
HV* CvSTASH(CV* cv)
- find_runcv
-
Locate the CV corresponding to the currently executing sub or eval.
If db_seqp is non_null, skip CVs that are in the DB package and populate
*db_seqp with the cop sequence number at the point that the DB:: code was
entered. (This allows debuggers to eval in the scope of the breakpoint
rather than in the scope of the debugger itself.)
CV* find_runcv(U32 *db_seqp)
- get_cv
-
Uses "strlen" to get the length of "name", then calls "get_cvn_flags".
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
CV* get_cv(const char* name, I32 flags)
- get_cvn_flags
-
Returns the CV of the specified Perl subroutine. "flags" are passed to
"gv_fetchpvn_flags". If "GV_ADD" is set and the Perl subroutine does not
exist then it will be declared (which has the same effect as saying
"sub name;"). If "GV_ADD" is not set and the subroutine does not exist
then NULL is returned.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
CV* get_cvn_flags(const char* name, STRLEN len, I32 flags)
Debugging Utilities
- dump_all
-
Dumps the entire optree of the current program starting at "PL_main_root" to
"STDERR". Also dumps the optrees for all visible subroutines in
"PL_defstash".
void dump_all()
- dump_packsubs
-
Dumps the optrees for all visible subroutines in "stash".
void dump_packsubs(const HV* stash)
- op_dump
-
Dumps the optree starting at OP "o" to "STDERR".
void op_dump(const OP *o)
- sv_dump
-
Dumps the contents of an SV to the "STDERR" filehandle.
For an example of its output, see Devel::Peek.
void sv_dump(SV* sv)
Display and Dump functions
- pv_display
-
Similar to
pv_escape(dsv,pv,cur,pvlim,PERL_PV_ESCAPE_QUOTE);
except that an additional ``\0'' will be appended to the string when len > cur and pv[cur] is ``\0''.
Note that the final string may be up to 7 chars longer than pvlim.
char* pv_display(SV *dsv, const char *pv, STRLEN cur, STRLEN len, STRLEN pvlim)
- pv_escape
-
Escapes at most the first ``count'' chars of pv and puts the results into
dsv such that the size of the escaped string will not exceed ``max'' chars
and will not contain any incomplete escape sequences. The number of bytes
escaped will be returned in the STRLEN *escaped parameter if it is not null.
When the dsv parameter is null no escaping actually occurs, but the number
of bytes that would be escaped were it not null will be calculated.
If flags contains PERL_PV_ESCAPE_QUOTE then any double quotes in the string will also be escaped.
Normally the SV will be cleared before the escaped string is prepared, but when PERL_PV_ESCAPE_NOCLEAR is set this will not occur.
If PERL_PV_ESCAPE_UNI is set then the input string is treated as UTF-8 if PERL_PV_ESCAPE_UNI_DETECT is set then the input string is scanned using "is_utf8_string()" to determine if it is UTF-8.
If PERL_PV_ESCAPE_ALL is set then all input chars will be output using "\x01F1" style escapes, otherwise if PERL_PV_ESCAPE_NONASCII is set, only non-ASCII chars will be escaped using this style; otherwise, only chars above 255 will be so escaped; other non printable chars will use octal or common escaped patterns like "\n". Otherwise, if PERL_PV_ESCAPE_NOBACKSLASH then all chars below 255 will be treated as printable and will be output as literals.
If PERL_PV_ESCAPE_FIRSTCHAR is set then only the first char of the string will be escaped, regardless of max. If the output is to be in hex, then it will be returned as a plain hex sequence. Thus the output will either be a single char, an octal escape sequence, a special escape like "\n" or a hex value.
If PERL_PV_ESCAPE_RE is set then the escape char used will be a '%' and not a '\\'. This is because regexes very often contain backslashed sequences, whereas '%' is not a particularly common character in patterns.
Returns a pointer to the escaped text as held by dsv.
char* pv_escape(SV *dsv, char const * const str, const STRLEN count, const STRLEN max, STRLEN * const escaped, const U32 flags)
- pv_pretty
-
Converts a string into something presentable, handling escaping via
pv_escape() and supporting quoting and ellipses.
If the PERL_PV_PRETTY_QUOTE flag is set then the result will be double quoted with any double quotes in the string escaped. Otherwise if the PERL_PV_PRETTY_LTGT flag is set then the result be wrapped in angle brackets.
If the PERL_PV_PRETTY_ELLIPSES flag is set and not all characters in string were output then an ellipsis "..." will be appended to the string. Note that this happens AFTER it has been quoted.
If start_color is non-null then it will be inserted after the opening quote (if there is one) but before the escaped text. If end_color is non-null then it will be inserted after the escaped text but before any quotes or ellipses.
Returns a pointer to the prettified text as held by dsv.
char* pv_pretty(SV *dsv, char const * const str, const STRLEN count, const STRLEN max, char const * const start_color, char const * const end_color, const U32 flags)
Embedding Functions
- cv_clone
-
Clone a CV, making a lexical closure. proto supplies the prototype
of the function: its code, pad structure, and other attributes.
The prototype is combined with a capture of outer lexicals to which the
code refers, which are taken from the currently-executing instance of
the immediately surrounding code.
CV * cv_clone(CV *proto)
- cv_name
-
Returns an SV containing the name of the CV, mainly for use in error
reporting. The CV may actually be a GV instead, in which case the returned
SV holds the GV's name. Anything other than a GV or CV is treated as a
string already holding the sub name, but this could change in the future.
An SV may be passed as a second argument. If so, the name will be assigned to it and it will be returned. Otherwise the returned SV will be a new mortal.
If the flags include CV_NAME_NOTQUAL, then the package name will not be included. If the first argument is neither a CV nor a GV, this flag is ignored (subject to change).
SV * cv_name(CV *cv, SV *sv, U32 flags)
- cv_undef
-
Clear out all the active components of a CV. This can happen either
by an explicit "undef &foo", or by the reference count going to zero.
In the former case, we keep the CvOUTSIDE pointer, so that any anonymous
children can still follow the full lexical scope chain.
void cv_undef(CV* cv)
- find_rundefsv
-
Find and return the variable that is named $_ in the lexical scope
of the currently-executing function. This may be a lexical $_,
or will otherwise be the global one.
SV * find_rundefsv()
- find_rundefsvoffset
-
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a
future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from
existing code.
Find the position of the lexical $_ in the pad of the currently-executing function. Returns the offset in the current pad, or "NOT_IN_PAD" if there is no lexical $_ in scope (in which case the global one should be used instead). ``find_rundefsv'' is likely to be more convenient.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
PADOFFSET find_rundefsvoffset()
- intro_my
-
``Introduce'' "my" variables to visible status. This is called during parsing
at the end of each statement to make lexical variables visible to subsequent
statements.
U32 intro_my()
- load_module
-
Loads the module whose name is pointed to by the string part of name.
Note that the actual module name, not its filename, should be given.
Eg, ``Foo::Bar'' instead of ``Foo/Bar.pm''. flags can be any of
PERL_LOADMOD_DENY, PERL_LOADMOD_NOIMPORT, or PERL_LOADMOD_IMPORT_OPS
(or 0 for no flags). ver, if specified
and not NULL, provides version semantics
similar to "use Foo::Bar VERSION". The optional trailing SV*
arguments can be used to specify arguments to the module's import()
method, similar to "use Foo::Bar VERSION LIST". They must be
terminated with a final NULL pointer. Note that this list can only
be omitted when the PERL_LOADMOD_NOIMPORT flag has been used.
Otherwise at least a single NULL pointer to designate the default
import list is required.
The reference count for each specified "SV*" parameter is decremented.
void load_module(U32 flags, SV* name, SV* ver, ...)
- newPADNAMELIST
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Creates a new pad name list. "max" is the highest index for which space is allocated.
PADNAMELIST * newPADNAMELIST(size_t max)
- newPADNAMEouter
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Constructs and returns a new pad name. Only use this function for names that refer to outer lexicals. (See also ``newPADNAMEpvn''.) outer is the outer pad name that this one mirrors. The returned pad name has the PADNAMEt_OUTER flag already set.
PADNAME * newPADNAMEouter(PADNAME *outer)
- newPADNAMEpvn
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Constructs and returns a new pad name. s must be a UTF8 string. Do not use this for pad names that point to outer lexicals. See ``newPADNAMEouter''.
PADNAME * newPADNAMEpvn(const char *s, STRLEN len)
- nothreadhook
-
Stub that provides thread hook for perl_destruct when there are
no threads.
int nothreadhook()
- padnamelist_fetch
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Fetches the pad name from the given index.
PADNAME * padnamelist_fetch(PADNAMELIST *pnl, SSize_t key)
- padnamelist_store
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Stores the pad name (which may be null) at the given index, freeing any existing pad name in that slot.
PADNAME ** padnamelist_store(PADNAMELIST *pnl, SSize_t key, PADNAME *val)
- pad_add_anon
-
Allocates a place in the currently-compiling pad (via ``pad_alloc'')
for an anonymous function that is lexically scoped inside the
currently-compiling function.
The function func is linked into the pad, and its "CvOUTSIDE" link
to the outer scope is weakened to avoid a reference loop.
One reference count is stolen, so you may need to do "SvREFCNT_inc(func)".
optype should be an opcode indicating the type of operation that the pad entry is to support. This doesn't affect operational semantics, but is used for debugging.
PADOFFSET pad_add_anon(CV *func, I32 optype)
- pad_add_name_pv
-
Exactly like ``pad_add_name_pvn'', but takes a nul-terminated string
instead of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_add_name_pv(const char *name, U32 flags, HV *typestash, HV *ourstash)
- pad_add_name_pvn
-
Allocates a place in the currently-compiling pad for a named lexical
variable. Stores the name and other metadata in the name part of the
pad, and makes preparations to manage the variable's lexical scoping.
Returns the offset of the allocated pad slot.
namepv/namelen specify the variable's name, including leading sigil. If typestash is non-null, the name is for a typed lexical, and this identifies the type. If ourstash is non-null, it's a lexical reference to a package variable, and this identifies the package. The following flags can be OR'ed together:
padadd_OUR redundantly specifies if it's a package var padadd_STATE variable will retain value persistently padadd_NO_DUP_CHECK skip check for lexical shadowing PADOFFSET pad_add_name_pvn(const char *namepv, STRLEN namelen, U32 flags, HV *typestash, HV *ourstash)
- pad_add_name_sv
-
Exactly like ``pad_add_name_pvn'', but takes the name string in the form
of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_add_name_sv(SV *name, U32 flags, HV *typestash, HV *ourstash)
- pad_alloc
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Allocates a place in the currently-compiling pad, returning the offset of the allocated pad slot. No name is initially attached to the pad slot. tmptype is a set of flags indicating the kind of pad entry required, which will be set in the value SV for the allocated pad entry:
SVs_PADMY named lexical variable ("my", "our", "state") SVs_PADTMP unnamed temporary store SVf_READONLY constant shared between recursion levels
"SVf_READONLY" has been supported here only since perl 5.20. To work with earlier versions as well, use "SVf_READONLY|SVs_PADTMP". "SVf_READONLY" does not cause the SV in the pad slot to be marked read-only, but simply tells "pad_alloc" that it will be made read-only (by the caller), or at least should be treated as such.
optype should be an opcode indicating the type of operation that the pad entry is to support. This doesn't affect operational semantics, but is used for debugging.
PADOFFSET pad_alloc(I32 optype, U32 tmptype)
- pad_findmy_pv
-
Exactly like ``pad_findmy_pvn'', but takes a nul-terminated string
instead of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_findmy_pv(const char *name, U32 flags)
- pad_findmy_pvn
-
Given the name of a lexical variable, find its position in the
currently-compiling pad.
namepv/namelen specify the variable's name, including leading sigil.
flags is reserved and must be zero.
If it is not in the current pad but appears in the pad of any lexically
enclosing scope, then a pseudo-entry for it is added in the current pad.
Returns the offset in the current pad,
or "NOT_IN_PAD" if no such lexical is in scope.
PADOFFSET pad_findmy_pvn(const char *namepv, STRLEN namelen, U32 flags)
- pad_findmy_sv
-
Exactly like ``pad_findmy_pvn'', but takes the name string in the form
of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_findmy_sv(SV *name, U32 flags)
- pad_setsv
-
Set the value at offset po in the current (compiling or executing) pad.
Use the macro PAD_SETSV() rather than calling this function directly.
void pad_setsv(PADOFFSET po, SV *sv)
- pad_sv
-
Get the value at offset po in the current (compiling or executing) pad.
Use macro PAD_SV instead of calling this function directly.
SV * pad_sv(PADOFFSET po)
- pad_tidy
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Tidy up a pad at the end of compilation of the code to which it belongs. Jobs performed here are: remove most stuff from the pads of anonsub prototypes; give it a @_; mark temporaries as such. type indicates the kind of subroutine:
padtidy_SUB ordinary subroutine padtidy_SUBCLONE prototype for lexical closure padtidy_FORMAT format void pad_tidy(padtidy_type type)
- perl_alloc
-
Allocates a new Perl interpreter. See perlembed.
PerlInterpreter* perl_alloc()
- perl_construct
-
Initializes a new Perl interpreter. See perlembed.
void perl_construct(PerlInterpreter *my_perl)
- perl_destruct
-
Shuts down a Perl interpreter. See perlembed.
int perl_destruct(PerlInterpreter *my_perl)
- perl_free
-
Releases a Perl interpreter. See perlembed.
void perl_free(PerlInterpreter *my_perl)
- perl_parse
-
Tells a Perl interpreter to parse a Perl script. See perlembed.
int perl_parse(PerlInterpreter *my_perl, XSINIT_t xsinit, int argc, char** argv, char** env)
- perl_run
-
Tells a Perl interpreter to run. See perlembed.
int perl_run(PerlInterpreter *my_perl)
- require_pv
-
Tells Perl to "require" the file named by the string argument. It is
analogous to the Perl code "eval "require '$file'"". It's even
implemented that way; consider using load_module instead.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void require_pv(const char* pv)
Exception Handling (simple) Macros
- dXCPT
-
Set up necessary local variables for exception handling.
See ``Exception Handling'' in perlguts.
dXCPT;
- XCPT_CATCH
- Introduces a catch block. See ``Exception Handling'' in perlguts.
- XCPT_RETHROW
-
Rethrows a previously caught exception. See ``Exception Handling'' in perlguts.
XCPT_RETHROW;
- XCPT_TRY_END
- Ends a try block. See ``Exception Handling'' in perlguts.
- XCPT_TRY_START
- Starts a try block. See ``Exception Handling'' in perlguts.
Global Variables
These variables are global to an entire process. They are shared between all interpreters and all threads in a process.- PL_check
-
Array, indexed by opcode, of functions that will be called for the ``check''
phase of optree building during compilation of Perl code. For most (but
not all) types of op, once the op has been initially built and populated
with child ops it will be filtered through the check function referenced
by the appropriate element of this array. The new op is passed in as the
sole argument to the check function, and the check function returns the
completed op. The check function may (as the name suggests) check the op
for validity and signal errors. It may also initialise or modify parts of
the ops, or perform more radical surgery such as adding or removing child
ops, or even throw the op away and return a different op in its place.
This array of function pointers is a convenient place to hook into the compilation process. An XS module can put its own custom check function in place of any of the standard ones, to influence the compilation of a particular type of op. However, a custom check function must never fully replace a standard check function (or even a custom check function from another module). A module modifying checking must instead wrap the preexisting check function. A custom check function must be selective about when to apply its custom behaviour. In the usual case where it decides not to do anything special with an op, it must chain the preexisting op function. Check functions are thus linked in a chain, with the core's base checker at the end.
For thread safety, modules should not write directly to this array. Instead, use the function ``wrap_op_checker''.
- PL_keyword_plugin
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Function pointer, pointing at a function used to handle extended keywords. The function should be declared as
int keyword_plugin_function(pTHX_ char *keyword_ptr, STRLEN keyword_len, OP **op_ptr)
The function is called from the tokeniser, whenever a possible keyword is seen. "keyword_ptr" points at the word in the parser's input buffer, and "keyword_len" gives its length; it is not null-terminated. The function is expected to examine the word, and possibly other state such as %^H, to decide whether it wants to handle it as an extended keyword. If it does not, the function should return "KEYWORD_PLUGIN_DECLINE", and the normal parser process will continue.
If the function wants to handle the keyword, it first must parse anything following the keyword that is part of the syntax introduced by the keyword. See ``Lexer interface'' for details.
When a keyword is being handled, the plugin function must build a tree of "OP" structures, representing the code that was parsed. The root of the tree must be stored in *op_ptr. The function then returns a constant indicating the syntactic role of the construct that it has parsed: "KEYWORD_PLUGIN_STMT" if it is a complete statement, or "KEYWORD_PLUGIN_EXPR" if it is an expression. Note that a statement construct cannot be used inside an expression (except via "do BLOCK" and similar), and an expression is not a complete statement (it requires at least a terminating semicolon).
When a keyword is handled, the plugin function may also have (compile-time) side effects. It may modify "%^H", define functions, and so on. Typically, if side effects are the main purpose of a handler, it does not wish to generate any ops to be included in the normal compilation. In this case it is still required to supply an op tree, but it suffices to generate a single null op.
That's how the *PL_keyword_plugin function needs to behave overall. Conventionally, however, one does not completely replace the existing handler function. Instead, take a copy of "PL_keyword_plugin" before assigning your own function pointer to it. Your handler function should look for keywords that it is interested in and handle those. Where it is not interested, it should call the saved plugin function, passing on the arguments it received. Thus "PL_keyword_plugin" actually points at a chain of handler functions, all of which have an opportunity to handle keywords, and only the last function in the chain (built into the Perl core) will normally return "KEYWORD_PLUGIN_DECLINE".
GV Functions
A GV is a structure which corresponds to to a Perl typeglob, ie *foo. It is a structure that holds a pointer to a scalar, an array, a hash etc, corresponding to $foo, @foo, %foo.GVs are usually found as values in stashes (symbol table hashes) where Perl stores its global variables.
- GvAV
-
Return the AV from the GV.
AV* GvAV(GV* gv)
- GvCV
-
Return the CV from the GV.
CV* GvCV(GV* gv)
- GvHV
-
Return the HV from the GV.
HV* GvHV(GV* gv)
- GvSV
-
Return the SV from the GV.
SV* GvSV(GV* gv)
- gv_const_sv
-
If "gv" is a typeglob whose subroutine entry is a constant sub eligible for
inlining, or "gv" is a placeholder reference that would be promoted to such
a typeglob, then returns the value returned by the sub. Otherwise, returns
NULL.
SV* gv_const_sv(GV* gv)
- gv_fetchmeth
-
Like ``gv_fetchmeth_pvn'', but lacks a flags parameter.
GV* gv_fetchmeth(HV* stash, const char* name, STRLEN len, I32 level)
- gv_fetchmethod_autoload
-
Returns the glob which contains the subroutine to call to invoke the method
on the "stash". In fact in the presence of autoloading this may be the
glob for ``AUTOLOAD''. In this case the corresponding variable $AUTOLOAD is
already setup.
The third parameter of "gv_fetchmethod_autoload" determines whether AUTOLOAD lookup is performed if the given method is not present: non-zero means yes, look for AUTOLOAD; zero means no, don't look for AUTOLOAD. Calling "gv_fetchmethod" is equivalent to calling "gv_fetchmethod_autoload" with a non-zero "autoload" parameter.
These functions grant "SUPER" token as a prefix of the method name. Note that if you want to keep the returned glob for a long time, you need to check for it being ``AUTOLOAD'', since at the later time the call may load a different subroutine due to $AUTOLOAD changing its value. Use the glob created as a side effect to do this.
These functions have the same side-effects as "gv_fetchmeth" with "level==0". The warning against passing the GV returned by "gv_fetchmeth" to "call_sv" applies equally to these functions.
GV* gv_fetchmethod_autoload(HV* stash, const char* name, I32 autoload)
- gv_fetchmeth_autoload
-
This is the old form of ``gv_fetchmeth_pvn_autoload'', which has no flags
parameter.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_autoload(HV* stash, const char* name, STRLEN len, I32 level)
- gv_fetchmeth_pv
-
Exactly like ``gv_fetchmeth_pvn'', but takes a nul-terminated string
instead of a string/length pair.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_pv(HV* stash, const char* name, I32 level, U32 flags)
- gv_fetchmeth_pvn
-
Returns the glob with the given "name" and a defined subroutine or
"NULL". The glob lives in the given "stash", or in the stashes
accessible via @ISA and UNIVERSAL::.
The argument "level" should be either 0 or -1. If "level==0", as a side-effect creates a glob with the given "name" in the given "stash" which in the case of success contains an alias for the subroutine, and sets up caching info for this glob.
The only significant values for "flags" are GV_SUPER and SVf_UTF8.
GV_SUPER indicates that we want to look up the method in the superclasses of the "stash".
The GV returned from "gv_fetchmeth" may be a method cache entry, which is not visible to Perl code. So when calling "call_sv", you should not use the GV directly; instead, you should use the method's CV, which can be obtained from the GV with the "GvCV" macro.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_pvn(HV* stash, const char* name, STRLEN len, I32 level, U32 flags)
- gv_fetchmeth_pvn_autoload
-
Same as gv_fetchmeth_pvn(), but looks for autoloaded subroutines too.
Returns a glob for the subroutine.
For an autoloaded subroutine without a GV, will create a GV even if "level < 0". For an autoloaded subroutine without a stub, GvCV() of the result may be zero.
Currently, the only significant value for "flags" is SVf_UTF8.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_pvn_autoload(HV* stash, const char* name, STRLEN len, I32 level, U32 flags)
- gv_fetchmeth_pv_autoload
-
Exactly like ``gv_fetchmeth_pvn_autoload'', but takes a nul-terminated string
instead of a string/length pair.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_pv_autoload(HV* stash, const char* name, I32 level, U32 flags)
- gv_fetchmeth_sv
-
Exactly like ``gv_fetchmeth_pvn'', but takes the name string in the form
of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_sv(HV* stash, SV* namesv, I32 level, U32 flags)
- gv_fetchmeth_sv_autoload
-
Exactly like ``gv_fetchmeth_pvn_autoload'', but takes the name string in the form
of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_sv_autoload(HV* stash, SV* namesv, I32 level, U32 flags)
- gv_init
-
The old form of gv_init_pvn(). It does not work with UTF8 strings, as it
has no flags parameter. If the "multi" parameter is set, the
GV_ADDMULTI flag will be passed to gv_init_pvn().
void gv_init(GV* gv, HV* stash, const char* name, STRLEN len, int multi)
- gv_init_pv
-
Same as gv_init_pvn(), but takes a nul-terminated string for the name
instead of separate char * and length parameters.
void gv_init_pv(GV* gv, HV* stash, const char* name, U32 flags)
- gv_init_pvn
-
Converts a scalar into a typeglob. This is an incoercible typeglob;
assigning a reference to it will assign to one of its slots, instead of
overwriting it as happens with typeglobs created by SvSetSV. Converting
any scalar that is SvOK() may produce unpredictable results and is reserved
for perl's internal use.
"gv" is the scalar to be converted.
"stash" is the parent stash/package, if any.
"name" and "len" give the name. The name must be unqualified; that is, it must not include the package name. If "gv" is a stash element, it is the caller's responsibility to ensure that the name passed to this function matches the name of the element. If it does not match, perl's internal bookkeeping will get out of sync.
"flags" can be set to SVf_UTF8 if "name" is a UTF8 string, or the return value of SvUTF8(sv). It can also take the GV_ADDMULTI flag, which means to pretend that the GV has been seen before (i.e., suppress ``Used once'' warnings).
void gv_init_pvn(GV* gv, HV* stash, const char* name, STRLEN len, U32 flags)
- gv_init_sv
-
Same as gv_init_pvn(), but takes an SV * for the name instead of separate
char * and length parameters. "flags" is currently unused.
void gv_init_sv(GV* gv, HV* stash, SV* namesv, U32 flags)
- gv_stashpv
-
Returns a pointer to the stash for a specified package. Uses "strlen" to
determine the length of "name", then calls "gv_stashpvn()".
HV* gv_stashpv(const char* name, I32 flags)
- gv_stashpvn
-
Returns a pointer to the stash for a specified package. The "namelen"
parameter indicates the length of the "name", in bytes. "flags" is passed
to "gv_fetchpvn_flags()", so if set to "GV_ADD" then the package will be
created if it does not already exist. If the package does not exist and
"flags" is 0 (or any other setting that does not create packages) then NULL
is returned.
Flags may be one of:
GV_ADD SVf_UTF8 GV_NOADD_NOINIT GV_NOINIT GV_NOEXPAND GV_ADDMG
The most important of which are probably GV_ADD and SVf_UTF8.
Note, use of "gv_stashsv" instead of "gv_stashpvn" where possible is strongly recommended for performance reasons.
HV* gv_stashpvn(const char* name, U32 namelen, I32 flags)
- gv_stashpvs
-
Like "gv_stashpvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
HV* gv_stashpvs(const char* name, I32 create)
- gv_stashsv
-
Returns a pointer to the stash for a specified package. See "gv_stashpvn".
Note this interface is strongly preferred over "gv_stashpvn" for performance reasons.
HV* gv_stashsv(SV* sv, I32 flags)
- setdefout
-
Sets PL_defoutgv, the default file handle for output, to the passed in
typeglob. As PL_defoutgv ``owns'' a reference on its typeglob, the reference
count of the passed in typeglob is increased by one, and the reference count
of the typeglob that PL_defoutgv points to is decreased by one.
void setdefout(GV* gv)
Handy Values
- Nullav
-
Null AV pointer.
(deprecated - use "(AV *)NULL" instead)
- Nullch
- Null character pointer. (No longer available when "PERL_CORE" is defined.)
- Nullcv
-
Null CV pointer.
(deprecated - use "(CV *)NULL" instead)
- Nullhv
-
Null HV pointer.
(deprecated - use "(HV *)NULL" instead)
- Nullsv
- Null SV pointer. (No longer available when "PERL_CORE" is defined.)
Hash Manipulation Functions
A HV structure represents a Perl hash. It consists mainly of an array of pointers, each of which points to a linked list of HE structures. The array is indexed by the hash function of the key, so each linked list represents all the hash entries with the same hash value. Each HE contains a pointer to the actual value, plus a pointer to a HEK structure which holds the key and hash value.- cop_fetch_label
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Returns the label attached to a cop. The flags pointer may be set to "SVf_UTF8" or 0.
const char * cop_fetch_label(COP *const cop, STRLEN *len, U32 *flags)
- cop_store_label
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Save a label into a "cop_hints_hash". You need to set flags to "SVf_UTF8" for a utf-8 label.
void cop_store_label(COP *const cop, const char *label, STRLEN len, U32 flags)
- get_hv
-
Returns the HV of the specified Perl hash. "flags" are passed to
"gv_fetchpv". If "GV_ADD" is set and the
Perl variable does not exist then it will be created. If "flags" is zero
and the variable does not exist then NULL is returned.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
HV* get_hv(const char *name, I32 flags)
- HEf_SVKEY
- This flag, used in the length slot of hash entries and magic structures, specifies the structure contains an "SV*" pointer where a "char*" pointer is to be expected. (For information only---not to be used).
- HeHASH
-
Returns the computed hash stored in the hash entry.
U32 HeHASH(HE* he)
- HeKEY
-
Returns the actual pointer stored in the key slot of the hash entry. The
pointer may be either "char*" or "SV*", depending on the value of
"HeKLEN()". Can be assigned to. The "HePV()" or "HeSVKEY()" macros are
usually preferable for finding the value of a key.
void* HeKEY(HE* he)
- HeKLEN
-
If this is negative, and amounts to "HEf_SVKEY", it indicates the entry
holds an "SV*" key. Otherwise, holds the actual length of the key. Can
be assigned to. The "HePV()" macro is usually preferable for finding key
lengths.
STRLEN HeKLEN(HE* he)
- HePV
-
Returns the key slot of the hash entry as a "char*" value, doing any
necessary dereferencing of possibly "SV*" keys. The length of the string
is placed in "len" (this is a macro, so do not use &len). If you do
not care about what the length of the key is, you may use the global
variable "PL_na", though this is rather less efficient than using a local
variable. Remember though, that hash keys in perl are free to contain
embedded nulls, so using "strlen()" or similar is not a good way to find
the length of hash keys. This is very similar to the "SvPV()" macro
described elsewhere in this document. See also "HeUTF8".
If you are using "HePV" to get values to pass to "newSVpvn()" to create a new SV, you should consider using "newSVhek(HeKEY_hek(he))" as it is more efficient.
char* HePV(HE* he, STRLEN len)
- HeSVKEY
-
Returns the key as an "SV*", or "NULL" if the hash entry does not
contain an "SV*" key.
SV* HeSVKEY(HE* he)
- HeSVKEY_force
-
Returns the key as an "SV*". Will create and return a temporary mortal
"SV*" if the hash entry contains only a "char*" key.
SV* HeSVKEY_force(HE* he)
- HeSVKEY_set
-
Sets the key to a given "SV*", taking care to set the appropriate flags to
indicate the presence of an "SV*" key, and returns the same
"SV*".
SV* HeSVKEY_set(HE* he, SV* sv)
- HeUTF8
-
Returns whether the "char *" value returned by "HePV" is encoded in UTF-8,
doing any necessary dereferencing of possibly "SV*" keys. The value returned
will be 0 or non-0, not necessarily 1 (or even a value with any low bits set),
so do not blindly assign this to a "bool" variable, as "bool" may be a
typedef for "char".
U32 HeUTF8(HE* he)
- HeVAL
-
Returns the value slot (type "SV*")
stored in the hash entry. Can be assigned
to.
SV *foo= HeVAL(hv); HeVAL(hv)= sv; SV* HeVAL(HE* he)
- HvENAME
-
Returns the effective name of a stash, or NULL if there is none. The
effective name represents a location in the symbol table where this stash
resides. It is updated automatically when packages are aliased or deleted.
A stash that is no longer in the symbol table has no effective name. This
name is preferable to "HvNAME" for use in MRO linearisations and isa
caches.
char* HvENAME(HV* stash)
- HvENAMELEN
-
Returns the length of the stash's effective name.
STRLEN HvENAMELEN(HV *stash)
- HvENAMEUTF8
-
Returns true if the effective name is in UTF8 encoding.
unsigned char HvENAMEUTF8(HV *stash)
- HvNAME
-
Returns the package name of a stash, or NULL if "stash" isn't a stash.
See "SvSTASH", "CvSTASH".
char* HvNAME(HV* stash)
- HvNAMELEN
-
Returns the length of the stash's name.
STRLEN HvNAMELEN(HV *stash)
- HvNAMEUTF8
-
Returns true if the name is in UTF8 encoding.
unsigned char HvNAMEUTF8(HV *stash)
- hv_assert
-
Check that a hash is in an internally consistent state.
void hv_assert(HV *hv)
- hv_clear
-
Frees the all the elements of a hash, leaving it empty.
The XS equivalent of "%hash = ()". See also ``hv_undef''.
See ``av_clear'' for a note about the hash possibly being invalid on return.
void hv_clear(HV *hv)
- hv_clear_placeholders
-
Clears any placeholders from a hash. If a restricted hash has any of its keys
marked as readonly and the key is subsequently deleted, the key is not actually
deleted but is marked by assigning it a value of &PL_sv_placeholder. This tags
it so it will be ignored by future operations such as iterating over the hash,
but will still allow the hash to have a value reassigned to the key at some
future point. This function clears any such placeholder keys from the hash.
See Hash::Util::lock_keys() for an example of its use.
void hv_clear_placeholders(HV *hv)
- hv_copy_hints_hv
-
A specialised version of ``newHVhv'' for copying "%^H". ohv must be
a pointer to a hash (which may have "%^H" magic, but should be generally
non-magical), or "NULL" (interpreted as an empty hash). The content
of ohv is copied to a new hash, which has the "%^H"-specific magic
added to it. A pointer to the new hash is returned.
HV * hv_copy_hints_hv(HV *ohv)
- hv_delete
-
Deletes a key/value pair in the hash. The value's SV is removed from
the hash, made mortal, and returned to the caller. The absolute
value of "klen" is the length of the key. If "klen" is negative the
key is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode. The "flags" value
will normally be zero; if set to G_DISCARD then NULL will be returned.
NULL will also be returned if the key is not found.
SV* hv_delete(HV *hv, const char *key, I32 klen, I32 flags)
- hv_delete_ent
-
Deletes a key/value pair in the hash. The value SV is removed from the hash,
made mortal, and returned to the caller. The "flags" value will normally be
zero; if set to G_DISCARD then NULL will be returned. NULL will also be
returned if the key is not found. "hash" can be a valid precomputed hash
value, or 0 to ask for it to be computed.
SV* hv_delete_ent(HV *hv, SV *keysv, I32 flags, U32 hash)
- hv_exists
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified hash key exists. The
absolute value of "klen" is the length of the key. If "klen" is
negative the key is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode.
bool hv_exists(HV *hv, const char *key, I32 klen)
- hv_exists_ent
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether
the specified hash key exists. "hash"
can be a valid precomputed hash value, or 0 to ask for it to be
computed.
bool hv_exists_ent(HV *hv, SV *keysv, U32 hash)
- hv_fetch
-
Returns the SV which corresponds to the specified key in the hash.
The absolute value of "klen" is the length of the key. If "klen" is
negative the key is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode. If
"lval" is set then the fetch will be part of a store. This means that if
there is no value in the hash associated with the given key, then one is
created and a pointer to it is returned. The "SV*" it points to can be
assigned to. But always check that the
return value is non-null before dereferencing it to an "SV*".
See ``Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays'' in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied hashes.
SV** hv_fetch(HV *hv, const char *key, I32 klen, I32 lval)
- hv_fetchs
-
Like "hv_fetch", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
SV** hv_fetchs(HV* tb, const char* key, I32 lval)
- hv_fetch_ent
-
Returns the hash entry which corresponds to the specified key in the hash.
"hash" must be a valid precomputed hash number for the given "key", or 0
if you want the function to compute it. IF "lval" is set then the fetch
will be part of a store. Make sure the return value is non-null before
accessing it. The return value when "hv" is a tied hash is a pointer to a
static location, so be sure to make a copy of the structure if you need to
store it somewhere.
See ``Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays'' in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied hashes.
HE* hv_fetch_ent(HV *hv, SV *keysv, I32 lval, U32 hash)
- hv_fill
-
Returns the number of hash buckets that
happen to be in use. This function is
wrapped by the macro "HvFILL".
Previously this value was always stored in the HV structure, which created an overhead on every hash (and pretty much every object) for something that was rarely used. Now we calculate it on demand the first time that it is needed, and cache it if that calculation is going to be costly to repeat. The cached value is updated by insertions and deletions, but (currently) discarded if the hash is split.
STRLEN hv_fill(HV *const hv)
- hv_iterinit
-
Prepares a starting point to traverse a hash table. Returns the number of
keys in the hash (i.e. the same as "HvUSEDKEYS(hv)"). The return value is
currently only meaningful for hashes without tie magic.
NOTE: Before version 5.004_65, "hv_iterinit" used to return the number of hash buckets that happen to be in use. If you still need that esoteric value, you can get it through the macro "HvFILL(hv)".
I32 hv_iterinit(HV *hv)
- hv_iterkey
-
Returns the key from the current position of the hash iterator. See
"hv_iterinit".
char* hv_iterkey(HE* entry, I32* retlen)
- hv_iterkeysv
-
Returns the key as an "SV*" from the current position of the hash
iterator. The return value will always be a mortal copy of the key. Also
see "hv_iterinit".
SV* hv_iterkeysv(HE* entry)
- hv_iternext
-
Returns entries from a hash iterator. See "hv_iterinit".
You may call "hv_delete" or "hv_delete_ent" on the hash entry that the iterator currently points to, without losing your place or invalidating your iterator. Note that in this case the current entry is deleted from the hash with your iterator holding the last reference to it. Your iterator is flagged to free the entry on the next call to "hv_iternext", so you must not discard your iterator immediately else the entry will leak - call "hv_iternext" to trigger the resource deallocation.
HE* hv_iternext(HV *hv)
- hv_iternextsv
-
Performs an "hv_iternext", "hv_iterkey", and "hv_iterval" in one
operation.
SV* hv_iternextsv(HV *hv, char **key, I32 *retlen)
- hv_iternext_flags
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Returns entries from a hash iterator. See "hv_iterinit" and "hv_iternext". The "flags" value will normally be zero; if HV_ITERNEXT_WANTPLACEHOLDERS is set the placeholders keys (for restricted hashes) will be returned in addition to normal keys. By default placeholders are automatically skipped over. Currently a placeholder is implemented with a value that is &PL_sv_placeholder. Note that the implementation of placeholders and restricted hashes may change, and the implementation currently is insufficiently abstracted for any change to be tidy.
HE* hv_iternext_flags(HV *hv, I32 flags)
- hv_iterval
-
Returns the value from the current position of the hash iterator. See
"hv_iterkey".
SV* hv_iterval(HV *hv, HE *entry)
- hv_magic
-
Adds magic to a hash. See "sv_magic".
void hv_magic(HV *hv, GV *gv, int how)
- hv_scalar
-
Evaluates the hash in scalar context and returns the result. Handles magic
when the hash is tied.
SV* hv_scalar(HV *hv)
- hv_store
-
Stores an SV in a hash. The hash key is specified as "key" and the
absolute value of "klen" is the length of the key. If "klen" is
negative the key is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode. The
"hash" parameter is the precomputed hash value; if it is zero then
Perl will compute it.
The return value will be NULL if the operation failed or if the value did not need to be actually stored within the hash (as in the case of tied hashes). Otherwise it can be dereferenced to get the original "SV*". Note that the caller is responsible for suitably incrementing the reference count of "val" before the call, and decrementing it if the function returned NULL. Effectively a successful hv_store takes ownership of one reference to "val". This is usually what you want; a newly created SV has a reference count of one, so if all your code does is create SVs then store them in a hash, hv_store will own the only reference to the new SV, and your code doesn't need to do anything further to tidy up. hv_store is not implemented as a call to hv_store_ent, and does not create a temporary SV for the key, so if your key data is not already in SV form then use hv_store in preference to hv_store_ent.
See ``Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays'' in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied hashes.
SV** hv_store(HV *hv, const char *key, I32 klen, SV *val, U32 hash)
- hv_stores
-
Like "hv_store", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair
and omits the hash parameter.
SV** hv_stores(HV* tb, const char* key, NULLOK SV* val)
- hv_store_ent
-
Stores "val" in a hash. The hash key is specified as "key". The "hash"
parameter is the precomputed hash value; if it is zero then Perl will
compute it. The return value is the new hash entry so created. It will be
NULL if the operation failed or if the value did not need to be actually
stored within the hash (as in the case of tied hashes). Otherwise the
contents of the return value can be accessed using the "He?" macros
described here. Note that the caller is responsible for suitably
incrementing the reference count of "val" before the call, and
decrementing it if the function returned NULL. Effectively a successful
hv_store_ent takes ownership of one reference to "val". This is
usually what you want; a newly created SV has a reference count of one, so
if all your code does is create SVs then store them in a hash, hv_store
will own the only reference to the new SV, and your code doesn't need to do
anything further to tidy up. Note that hv_store_ent only reads the "key";
unlike "val" it does not take ownership of it, so maintaining the correct
reference count on "key" is entirely the caller's responsibility. hv_store
is not implemented as a call to hv_store_ent, and does not create a temporary
SV for the key, so if your key data is not already in SV form then use
hv_store in preference to hv_store_ent.
See ``Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays'' in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied hashes.
HE* hv_store_ent(HV *hv, SV *key, SV *val, U32 hash)
- hv_undef
-
Undefines the hash. The XS equivalent of "undef(%hash)".
As well as freeing all the elements of the hash (like hv_clear()), this also frees any auxiliary data and storage associated with the hash.
See ``av_clear'' for a note about the hash possibly being invalid on return.
void hv_undef(HV *hv)
- newHV
-
Creates a new HV. The reference count is set to 1.
HV* newHV()
Hook manipulation
These functions provide convenient and thread-safe means of manipulating hook variables.- wrap_op_checker
-
Puts a C function into the chain of check functions for a specified op
type. This is the preferred way to manipulate the ``PL_check'' array.
opcode specifies which type of op is to be affected. new_checker
is a pointer to the C function that is to be added to that opcode's
check chain, and old_checker_p points to the storage location where a
pointer to the next function in the chain will be stored. The value of
new_pointer is written into the ``PL_check'' array, while the value
previously stored there is written to *old_checker_p.
The function should be defined like this:
static OP *new_checker(pTHX_ OP *op) { ... }
It is intended to be called in this manner:
new_checker(aTHX_ op)
old_checker_p should be defined like this:
static Perl_check_t old_checker_p;
``PL_check'' is global to an entire process, and a module wishing to hook op checking may find itself invoked more than once per process, typically in different threads. To handle that situation, this function is idempotent. The location *old_checker_p must initially (once per process) contain a null pointer. A C variable of static duration (declared at file scope, typically also marked "static" to give it internal linkage) will be implicitly initialised appropriately, if it does not have an explicit initialiser. This function will only actually modify the check chain if it finds *old_checker_p to be null. This function is also thread safe on the small scale. It uses appropriate locking to avoid race conditions in accessing ``PL_check''.
When this function is called, the function referenced by new_checker must be ready to be called, except for *old_checker_p being unfilled. In a threading situation, new_checker may be called immediately, even before this function has returned. *old_checker_p will always be appropriately set before new_checker is called. If new_checker decides not to do anything special with an op that it is given (which is the usual case for most uses of op check hooking), it must chain the check function referenced by *old_checker_p.
If you want to influence compilation of calls to a specific subroutine, then use ``cv_set_call_checker'' rather than hooking checking of all "entersub" ops.
void wrap_op_checker(Optype opcode, Perl_check_t new_checker, Perl_check_t *old_checker_p)
Lexer interface
This is the lower layer of the Perl parser, managing characters and tokens.- lex_bufutf8
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Indicates whether the octets in the lexer buffer (``PL_parser->linestr'') should be interpreted as the UTF-8 encoding of Unicode characters. If not, they should be interpreted as Latin-1 characters. This is analogous to the "SvUTF8" flag for scalars.
In UTF-8 mode, it is not guaranteed that the lexer buffer actually contains valid UTF-8. Lexing code must be robust in the face of invalid encoding.
The actual "SvUTF8" flag of the ``PL_parser->linestr'' scalar is significant, but not the whole story regarding the input character encoding. Normally, when a file is being read, the scalar contains octets and its "SvUTF8" flag is off, but the octets should be interpreted as UTF-8 if the "use utf8" pragma is in effect. During a string eval, however, the scalar may have the "SvUTF8" flag on, and in this case its octets should be interpreted as UTF-8 unless the "use bytes" pragma is in effect. This logic may change in the future; use this function instead of implementing the logic yourself.
bool lex_bufutf8()
- lex_discard_to
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Discards the first part of the ``PL_parser->linestr'' buffer, up to ptr. The remaining content of the buffer will be moved, and all pointers into the buffer updated appropriately. ptr must not be later in the buffer than the position of ``PL_parser->bufptr'': it is not permitted to discard text that has yet to be lexed.
Normally it is not necessarily to do this directly, because it suffices to use the implicit discarding behaviour of ``lex_next_chunk'' and things based on it. However, if a token stretches across multiple lines, and the lexing code has kept multiple lines of text in the buffer for that purpose, then after completion of the token it would be wise to explicitly discard the now-unneeded earlier lines, to avoid future multi-line tokens growing the buffer without bound.
void lex_discard_to(char *ptr)
- lex_grow_linestr
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Reallocates the lexer buffer (``PL_parser->linestr'') to accommodate at least len octets (including terminating "NUL"). Returns a pointer to the reallocated buffer. This is necessary before making any direct modification of the buffer that would increase its length. ``lex_stuff_pvn'' provides a more convenient way to insert text into the buffer.
Do not use "SvGROW" or "sv_grow" directly on "PL_parser->linestr"; this function updates all of the lexer's variables that point directly into the buffer.
char * lex_grow_linestr(STRLEN len)
- lex_next_chunk
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Reads in the next chunk of text to be lexed, appending it to ``PL_parser->linestr''. This should be called when lexing code has looked to the end of the current chunk and wants to know more. It is usual, but not necessary, for lexing to have consumed the entirety of the current chunk at this time.
If ``PL_parser->bufptr'' is pointing to the very end of the current chunk (i.e., the current chunk has been entirely consumed), normally the current chunk will be discarded at the same time that the new chunk is read in. If flags includes "LEX_KEEP_PREVIOUS", the current chunk will not be discarded. If the current chunk has not been entirely consumed, then it will not be discarded regardless of the flag.
Returns true if some new text was added to the buffer, or false if the buffer has reached the end of the input text.
bool lex_next_chunk(U32 flags)
- lex_peek_unichar
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Looks ahead one (Unicode) character in the text currently being lexed. Returns the codepoint (unsigned integer value) of the next character, or -1 if lexing has reached the end of the input text. To consume the peeked character, use ``lex_read_unichar''.
If the next character is in (or extends into) the next chunk of input text, the next chunk will be read in. Normally the current chunk will be discarded at the same time, but if flags includes "LEX_KEEP_PREVIOUS" then the current chunk will not be discarded.
If the input is being interpreted as UTF-8 and a UTF-8 encoding error is encountered, an exception is generated.
I32 lex_peek_unichar(U32 flags)
- lex_read_space
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Reads optional spaces, in Perl style, in the text currently being lexed. The spaces may include ordinary whitespace characters and Perl-style comments. "#line" directives are processed if encountered. ``PL_parser->bufptr'' is moved past the spaces, so that it points at a non-space character (or the end of the input text).
If spaces extend into the next chunk of input text, the next chunk will be read in. Normally the current chunk will be discarded at the same time, but if flags includes "LEX_KEEP_PREVIOUS" then the current chunk will not be discarded.
void lex_read_space(U32 flags)
- lex_read_to
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Consume text in the lexer buffer, from ``PL_parser->bufptr'' up to ptr. This advances ``PL_parser->bufptr'' to match ptr, performing the correct bookkeeping whenever a newline character is passed. This is the normal way to consume lexed text.
Interpretation of the buffer's octets can be abstracted out by using the slightly higher-level functions ``lex_peek_unichar'' and ``lex_read_unichar''.
void lex_read_to(char *ptr)
- lex_read_unichar
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Reads the next (Unicode) character in the text currently being lexed. Returns the codepoint (unsigned integer value) of the character read, and moves ``PL_parser->bufptr'' past the character, or returns -1 if lexing has reached the end of the input text. To non-destructively examine the next character, use ``lex_peek_unichar'' instead.
If the next character is in (or extends into) the next chunk of input text, the next chunk will be read in. Normally the current chunk will be discarded at the same time, but if flags includes "LEX_KEEP_PREVIOUS" then the current chunk will not be discarded.
If the input is being interpreted as UTF-8 and a UTF-8 encoding error is encountered, an exception is generated.
I32 lex_read_unichar(U32 flags)
- lex_start
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Creates and initialises a new lexer/parser state object, supplying a context in which to lex and parse from a new source of Perl code. A pointer to the new state object is placed in ``PL_parser''. An entry is made on the save stack so that upon unwinding the new state object will be destroyed and the former value of ``PL_parser'' will be restored. Nothing else need be done to clean up the parsing context.
The code to be parsed comes from line and rsfp. line, if non-null, provides a string (in SV form) containing code to be parsed. A copy of the string is made, so subsequent modification of line does not affect parsing. rsfp, if non-null, provides an input stream from which code will be read to be parsed. If both are non-null, the code in line comes first and must consist of complete lines of input, and rsfp supplies the remainder of the source.
The flags parameter is reserved for future use. Currently it is only used by perl internally, so extensions should always pass zero.
void lex_start(SV *line, PerlIO *rsfp, U32 flags)
- lex_stuff_pv
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Insert characters into the lexer buffer (``PL_parser->linestr''), immediately after the current lexing point (``PL_parser->bufptr''), reallocating the buffer if necessary. This means that lexing code that runs later will see the characters as if they had appeared in the input. It is not recommended to do this as part of normal parsing, and most uses of this facility run the risk of the inserted characters being interpreted in an unintended manner.
The string to be inserted is represented by octets starting at pv and continuing to the first nul. These octets are interpreted as either UTF-8 or Latin-1, according to whether the "LEX_STUFF_UTF8" flag is set in flags. The characters are recoded for the lexer buffer, according to how the buffer is currently being interpreted (``lex_bufutf8''). If it is not convenient to nul-terminate a string to be inserted, the ``lex_stuff_pvn'' function is more appropriate.
void lex_stuff_pv(const char *pv, U32 flags)
- lex_stuff_pvn
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Insert characters into the lexer buffer (``PL_parser->linestr''), immediately after the current lexing point (``PL_parser->bufptr''), reallocating the buffer if necessary. This means that lexing code that runs later will see the characters as if they had appeared in the input. It is not recommended to do this as part of normal parsing, and most uses of this facility run the risk of the inserted characters being interpreted in an unintended manner.
The string to be inserted is represented by len octets starting at pv. These octets are interpreted as either UTF-8 or Latin-1, according to whether the "LEX_STUFF_UTF8" flag is set in flags. The characters are recoded for the lexer buffer, according to how the buffer is currently being interpreted (``lex_bufutf8''). If a string to be inserted is available as a Perl scalar, the ``lex_stuff_sv'' function is more convenient.
void lex_stuff_pvn(const char *pv, STRLEN len, U32 flags)
- lex_stuff_pvs
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Like ``lex_stuff_pvn'', but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void lex_stuff_pvs(const char *pv, U32 flags)
- lex_stuff_sv
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Insert characters into the lexer buffer (``PL_parser->linestr''), immediately after the current lexing point (``PL_parser->bufptr''), reallocating the buffer if necessary. This means that lexing code that runs later will see the characters as if they had appeared in the input. It is not recommended to do this as part of normal parsing, and most uses of this facility run the risk of the inserted characters being interpreted in an unintended manner.
The string to be inserted is the string value of sv. The characters are recoded for the lexer buffer, according to how the buffer is currently being interpreted (``lex_bufutf8''). If a string to be inserted is not already a Perl scalar, the ``lex_stuff_pvn'' function avoids the need to construct a scalar.
void lex_stuff_sv(SV *sv, U32 flags)
- lex_unstuff
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Discards text about to be lexed, from ``PL_parser->bufptr'' up to ptr. Text following ptr will be moved, and the buffer shortened. This hides the discarded text from any lexing code that runs later, as if the text had never appeared.
This is not the normal way to consume lexed text. For that, use ``lex_read_to''.
void lex_unstuff(char *ptr)
- parse_arithexpr
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Parse a Perl arithmetic expression. This may contain operators of precedence down to the bit shift operators. The expression must be followed (and thus terminated) either by a comparison or lower-precedence operator or by something that would normally terminate an expression such as semicolon. If flags includes "PARSE_OPTIONAL" then the expression is optional, otherwise it is mandatory. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state (``PL_parser'' et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the expression.
The op tree representing the expression is returned. If an optional expression is absent, a null pointer is returned, otherwise the pointer will be non-null.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
OP * parse_arithexpr(U32 flags)
- parse_barestmt
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Parse a single unadorned Perl statement. This may be a normal imperative statement or a declaration that has compile-time effect. It does not include any label or other affixture. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state (``PL_parser'' et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the statement.
The op tree representing the statement is returned. This may be a null pointer if the statement is null, for example if it was actually a subroutine definition (which has compile-time side effects). If not null, it will be ops directly implementing the statement, suitable to pass to ``newSTATEOP''. It will not normally include a "nextstate" or equivalent op (except for those embedded in a scope contained entirely within the statement).
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree (most likely null) is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
The flags parameter is reserved for future use, and must always be zero.
OP * parse_barestmt(U32 flags)
- parse_block
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Parse a single complete Perl code block. This consists of an opening brace, a sequence of statements, and a closing brace. The block constitutes a lexical scope, so "my" variables and various compile-time effects can be contained within it. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state (``PL_parser'' et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the statement.
The op tree representing the code block is returned. This is always a real op, never a null pointer. It will normally be a "lineseq" list, including "nextstate" or equivalent ops. No ops to construct any kind of runtime scope are included by virtue of it being a block.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree (most likely null) is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
The flags parameter is reserved for future use, and must always be zero.
OP * parse_block(U32 flags)
- parse_fullexpr
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Parse a single complete Perl expression. This allows the full expression grammar, including the lowest-precedence operators such as "or". The expression must be followed (and thus terminated) by a token that an expression would normally be terminated by: end-of-file, closing bracketing punctuation, semicolon, or one of the keywords that signals a postfix expression-statement modifier. If flags includes "PARSE_OPTIONAL" then the expression is optional, otherwise it is mandatory. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state (``PL_parser'' et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the expression.
The op tree representing the expression is returned. If an optional expression is absent, a null pointer is returned, otherwise the pointer will be non-null.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
OP * parse_fullexpr(U32 flags)
- parse_fullstmt
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Parse a single complete Perl statement. This may be a normal imperative statement or a declaration that has compile-time effect, and may include optional labels. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state (``PL_parser'' et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the statement.
The op tree representing the statement is returned. This may be a null pointer if the statement is null, for example if it was actually a subroutine definition (which has compile-time side effects). If not null, it will be the result of a ``newSTATEOP'' call, normally including a "nextstate" or equivalent op.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree (most likely null) is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
The flags parameter is reserved for future use, and must always be zero.
OP * parse_fullstmt(U32 flags)
- parse_label
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Parse a single label, possibly optional, of the type that may prefix a Perl statement. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state (``PL_parser'' et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed. If flags includes "PARSE_OPTIONAL" then the label is optional, otherwise it is mandatory.
The name of the label is returned in the form of a fresh scalar. If an optional label is absent, a null pointer is returned.
If an error occurs in parsing, which can only occur if the label is mandatory, a valid label is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred.
SV * parse_label(U32 flags)
- parse_listexpr
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Parse a Perl list expression. This may contain operators of precedence down to the comma operator. The expression must be followed (and thus terminated) either by a low-precedence logic operator such as "or" or by something that would normally terminate an expression such as semicolon. If flags includes "PARSE_OPTIONAL" then the expression is optional, otherwise it is mandatory. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state (``PL_parser'' et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the expression.
The op tree representing the expression is returned. If an optional expression is absent, a null pointer is returned, otherwise the pointer will be non-null.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
OP * parse_listexpr(U32 flags)
- parse_stmtseq
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Parse a sequence of zero or more Perl statements. These may be normal imperative statements, including optional labels, or declarations that have compile-time effect, or any mixture thereof. The statement sequence ends when a closing brace or end-of-file is encountered in a place where a new statement could have validly started. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state (``PL_parser'' et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the statements.
The op tree representing the statement sequence is returned. This may be a null pointer if the statements were all null, for example if there were no statements or if there were only subroutine definitions (which have compile-time side effects). If not null, it will be a "lineseq" list, normally including "nextstate" or equivalent ops.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
The flags parameter is reserved for future use, and must always be zero.
OP * parse_stmtseq(U32 flags)
- parse_termexpr
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Parse a Perl term expression. This may contain operators of precedence down to the assignment operators. The expression must be followed (and thus terminated) either by a comma or lower-precedence operator or by something that would normally terminate an expression such as semicolon. If flags includes "PARSE_OPTIONAL" then the expression is optional, otherwise it is mandatory. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state (``PL_parser'' et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the expression.
The op tree representing the expression is returned. If an optional expression is absent, a null pointer is returned, otherwise the pointer will be non-null.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
OP * parse_termexpr(U32 flags)
- PL_parser
- Pointer to a structure encapsulating the state of the parsing operation currently in progress. The pointer can be locally changed to perform a nested parse without interfering with the state of an outer parse. Individual members of "PL_parser" have their own documentation.
- PL_parser->bufend
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Direct pointer to the end of the chunk of text currently being lexed, the end of the lexer buffer. This is equal to "SvPVX(PL_parser->linestr) + SvCUR(PL_parser->linestr)". A "NUL" character (zero octet) is always located at the end of the buffer, and does not count as part of the buffer's contents.
- PL_parser->bufptr
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Points to the current position of lexing inside the lexer buffer. Characters around this point may be freely examined, within the range delimited by "SvPVX("PL_parser->linestr")" and ``PL_parser->bufend''. The octets of the buffer may be intended to be interpreted as either UTF-8 or Latin-1, as indicated by ``lex_bufutf8''.
Lexing code (whether in the Perl core or not) moves this pointer past the characters that it consumes. It is also expected to perform some bookkeeping whenever a newline character is consumed. This movement can be more conveniently performed by the function ``lex_read_to'', which handles newlines appropriately.
Interpretation of the buffer's octets can be abstracted out by using the slightly higher-level functions ``lex_peek_unichar'' and ``lex_read_unichar''.
- PL_parser->linestart
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Points to the start of the current line inside the lexer buffer. This is useful for indicating at which column an error occurred, and not much else. This must be updated by any lexing code that consumes a newline; the function ``lex_read_to'' handles this detail.
- PL_parser->linestr
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Buffer scalar containing the chunk currently under consideration of the text currently being lexed. This is always a plain string scalar (for which "SvPOK" is true). It is not intended to be used as a scalar by normal scalar means; instead refer to the buffer directly by the pointer variables described below.
The lexer maintains various "char*" pointers to things in the "PL_parser->linestr" buffer. If "PL_parser->linestr" is ever reallocated, all of these pointers must be updated. Don't attempt to do this manually, but rather use ``lex_grow_linestr'' if you need to reallocate the buffer.
The content of the text chunk in the buffer is commonly exactly one complete line of input, up to and including a newline terminator, but there are situations where it is otherwise. The octets of the buffer may be intended to be interpreted as either UTF-8 or Latin-1. The function ``lex_bufutf8'' tells you which. Do not use the "SvUTF8" flag on this scalar, which may disagree with it.
For direct examination of the buffer, the variable ``PL_parser->bufend'' points to the end of the buffer. The current lexing position is pointed to by ``PL_parser->bufptr''. Direct use of these pointers is usually preferable to examination of the scalar through normal scalar means.
Locale-related functions and macros
- DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION
-
This macro should be used as a statement. It declares a private variable
(whose name begins with an underscore) that is needed by the other macros in
this section. Failing to include this correctly should lead to a syntax error.
For compatibility with C89 C compilers it should be placed in a block before
any executable statements.
void DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION
- RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC
-
This is used in conjunction with one of the macros
``STORE_LC_NUMERIC_SET_TO_NEEDED''
and
``STORE_LC_NUMERIC_FORCE_TO_UNDERLYING''
to properly restore the "LC_NUMERIC" state.
A call to ``DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION'' must have been made to declare at compile time a private variable used by this macro and the two "STORE" ones. This macro should be called as a single statement, not an expression, but with an empty argument list, like this:
{ DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION; ... RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC(); ... } void RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC()
- STORE_LC_NUMERIC_FORCE_TO_UNDERLYING
-
This is used by XS code that that is "LC_NUMERIC" locale-aware to force the
locale for category "LC_NUMERIC" to be what perl thinks is the current
underlying locale. (The perl interpreter could be wrong about what the
underlying locale actually is if some C or XS code has called the C library
function setlocale(3) behind its back; calling ``sync_locale'' before calling
this macro will update perl's records.)
A call to ``DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION'' must have been made to declare at compile time a private variable used by this macro. This macro should be called as a single statement, not an expression, but with an empty argument list, like this:
{ DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION; ... STORE_LC_NUMERIC_FORCE_TO_UNDERLYING(); ... RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC(); ... }
The private variable is used to save the current locale state, so that the requisite matching call to ``RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC'' can restore it.
void STORE_LC_NUMERIC_FORCE_TO_UNDERLYING()
- STORE_LC_NUMERIC_SET_TO_NEEDED
-
This is used to help wrap XS or C code that that is "LC_NUMERIC" locale-aware.
This locale category is generally kept set to the C locale by Perl for
backwards compatibility, and because most XS code that reads floating point
values can cope only with the decimal radix character being a dot.
This macro makes sure the current "LC_NUMERIC" state is set properly, to be aware of locale if the call to the XS or C code from the Perl program is from within the scope of a "use locale"; or to ignore locale if the call is instead from outside such scope.
This macro is the start of wrapping the C or XS code; the wrap ending is done by calling the ``RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC'' macro after the operation. Otherwise the state can be changed that will adversely affect other XS code.
A call to ``DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION'' must have been made to declare at compile time a private variable used by this macro. This macro should be called as a single statement, not an expression, but with an empty argument list, like this:
{ DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION; ... STORE_LC_NUMERIC_SET_TO_NEEDED(); ... RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC(); ... } void STORE_LC_NUMERIC_SET_TO_NEEDED()
- sync_locale
-
Changing the program's locale should be avoided by XS code. Nevertheless,
certain non-Perl libraries called from XS, such as "Gtk" do so. When this
happens, Perl needs to be told that the locale has changed. Use this function
to do so, before returning to Perl.
void sync_locale()
Magical Functions
- mg_clear
-
Clear something magical that the SV represents. See "sv_magic".
int mg_clear(SV* sv)
- mg_copy
-
Copies the magic from one SV to another. See "sv_magic".
int mg_copy(SV *sv, SV *nsv, const char *key, I32 klen)
- mg_find
-
Finds the magic pointer for type matching the SV. See "sv_magic".
MAGIC* mg_find(const SV* sv, int type)
- mg_findext
-
Finds the magic pointer of "type" with the given "vtbl" for the "SV". See
"sv_magicext".
MAGIC* mg_findext(const SV* sv, int type, const MGVTBL *vtbl)
- mg_free
-
Free any magic storage used by the SV. See "sv_magic".
int mg_free(SV* sv)
- mg_free_type
-
Remove any magic of type how from the SV sv. See ``sv_magic''.
void mg_free_type(SV *sv, int how)
- mg_get
-
Do magic before a value is retrieved from the SV. The type of SV must
be >= SVt_PVMG. See "sv_magic".
int mg_get(SV* sv)
- mg_length
-
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a
future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from
existing code.
Reports on the SV's length in bytes, calling length magic if available, but does not set the UTF8 flag on the sv. It will fall back to 'get' magic if there is no 'length' magic, but with no indication as to whether it called 'get' magic. It assumes the sv is a PVMG or higher. Use sv_len() instead.
U32 mg_length(SV* sv)
- mg_magical
-
Turns on the magical status of an SV. See "sv_magic".
void mg_magical(SV* sv)
- mg_set
-
Do magic after a value is assigned to the SV. See "sv_magic".
int mg_set(SV* sv)
- SvGETMAGIC
-
Invokes "mg_get" on an SV if it has 'get' magic. For example, this
will call "FETCH" on a tied variable. This macro evaluates its
argument more than once.
void SvGETMAGIC(SV* sv)
- SvLOCK
-
Arranges for a mutual exclusion lock to be obtained on sv if a suitable module
has been loaded.
void SvLOCK(SV* sv)
- SvSETMAGIC
-
Invokes "mg_set" on an SV if it has 'set' magic. This is necessary
after modifying a scalar, in case it is a magical variable like $|
or a tied variable (it calls "STORE"). This macro evaluates its
argument more than once.
void SvSETMAGIC(SV* sv)
- SvSetMagicSV
-
Like "SvSetSV", but does any set magic required afterwards.
void SvSetMagicSV(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
- SvSetMagicSV_nosteal
-
Like "SvSetSV_nosteal", but does any set magic required afterwards.
void SvSetMagicSV_nosteal(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
- SvSetSV
-
Calls "sv_setsv" if dsv is not the same as ssv. May evaluate arguments
more than once. Does not handle 'set' magic on the destination SV.
void SvSetSV(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
- SvSetSV_nosteal
-
Calls a non-destructive version of "sv_setsv" if dsv is not the same as
ssv. May evaluate arguments more than once.
void SvSetSV_nosteal(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
- SvSHARE
-
Arranges for sv to be shared between threads if a suitable module
has been loaded.
void SvSHARE(SV* sv)
- SvUNLOCK
-
Releases a mutual exclusion lock on sv if a suitable module
has been loaded.
void SvUNLOCK(SV* sv)
Memory Management
- Copy
-
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C "memcpy" function. The "src" is the
source, "dest" is the destination, "nitems" is the number of items, and
"type" is the type. May fail on overlapping copies. See also "Move".
void Copy(void* src, void* dest, int nitems, type)
- CopyD
-
Like "Copy" but returns dest. Useful
for encouraging compilers to tail-call
optimise.
void * CopyD(void* src, void* dest, int nitems, type)
- Move
-
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C "memmove" function. The "src" is the
source, "dest" is the destination, "nitems" is the number of items, and
"type" is the type. Can do overlapping moves. See also "Copy".
void Move(void* src, void* dest, int nitems, type)
- MoveD
-
Like "Move" but returns dest. Useful
for encouraging compilers to tail-call
optimise.
void * MoveD(void* src, void* dest, int nitems, type)
- Newx
-
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C "malloc" function.
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with ``Safefree''.
In 5.9.3, Newx() and friends replace the older New() API, and drops the first parameter, x, a debug aid which allowed callers to identify themselves. This aid has been superseded by a new build option, PERL_MEM_LOG (see ``PERL_MEM_LOG'' in perlhacktips). The older API is still there for use in XS modules supporting older perls.
void Newx(void* ptr, int nitems, type)
- Newxc
-
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C "malloc" function, with
cast. See also "Newx".
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with ``Safefree''.
void Newxc(void* ptr, int nitems, type, cast)
- Newxz
-
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C "malloc" function. The allocated
memory is zeroed with "memzero". See also "Newx".
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with ``Safefree''.
void Newxz(void* ptr, int nitems, type)
- Poison
-
PoisonWith(0xEF) for catching access to freed memory.
void Poison(void* dest, int nitems, type)
- PoisonFree
-
PoisonWith(0xEF) for catching access to freed memory.
void PoisonFree(void* dest, int nitems, type)
- PoisonNew
-
PoisonWith(0xAB) for catching access to allocated but uninitialized memory.
void PoisonNew(void* dest, int nitems, type)
- PoisonWith
-
Fill up memory with a byte pattern (a byte repeated over and over
again) that hopefully catches attempts to access uninitialized memory.
void PoisonWith(void* dest, int nitems, type, U8 byte)
- Renew
-
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C "realloc" function.
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with ``Safefree''.
void Renew(void* ptr, int nitems, type)
- Renewc
-
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C "realloc" function, with
cast.
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with ``Safefree''.
void Renewc(void* ptr, int nitems, type, cast)
- Safefree
-
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C "free" function.
This should ONLY be used on memory obtained using ``Newx'' and friends.
void Safefree(void* ptr)
- savepv
-
Perl's version of "strdup()". Returns a pointer to a newly allocated
string which is a duplicate of "pv". The size of the string is
determined by "strlen()", which means it may not contain embedded "NUL"
characters and must have a trailing "NUL". The memory allocated for the new
string can be freed with the "Safefree()" function.
On some platforms, Windows for example, all allocated memory owned by a thread is deallocated when that thread ends. So if you need that not to happen, you need to use the shared memory functions, such as "savesharedpv".
char* savepv(const char* pv)
- savepvn
-
Perl's version of what "strndup()" would be if it existed. Returns a
pointer to a newly allocated string which is a duplicate of the first
"len" bytes from "pv", plus a trailing
"NUL" byte. The memory allocated for
the new string can be freed with the "Safefree()" function.
On some platforms, Windows for example, all allocated memory owned by a thread is deallocated when that thread ends. So if you need that not to happen, you need to use the shared memory functions, such as "savesharedpvn".
char* savepvn(const char* pv, I32 len)
- savepvs
-
Like "savepvn", but takes a literal "NUL"-terminated string instead of a
string/length pair.
char* savepvs(const char* s)
- savesharedpv
-
A version of "savepv()" which allocates the duplicate string in memory
which is shared between threads.
char* savesharedpv(const char* pv)
- savesharedpvn
-
A version of "savepvn()" which allocates the duplicate string in memory
which is shared between threads. (With the specific difference that a NULL
pointer is not acceptable)
char* savesharedpvn(const char *const pv, const STRLEN len)
- savesharedpvs
-
A version of "savepvs()" which allocates the duplicate string in memory
which is shared between threads.
char* savesharedpvs(const char* s)
- savesharedsvpv
-
A version of "savesharedpv()" which allocates the duplicate string in
memory which is shared between threads.
char* savesharedsvpv(SV *sv)
- savesvpv
-
A version of "savepv()"/"savepvn()" which gets the string to duplicate from
the passed in SV using "SvPV()"
On some platforms, Windows for example, all allocated memory owned by a thread is deallocated when that thread ends. So if you need that not to happen, you need to use the shared memory functions, such as "savesharedsvpv".
char* savesvpv(SV* sv)
- StructCopy
-
This is an architecture-independent macro to copy one structure to another.
void StructCopy(type *src, type *dest, type)
- Zero
-
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C "memzero" function. The "dest" is the
destination, "nitems" is the number of items, and "type" is the type.
void Zero(void* dest, int nitems, type)
- ZeroD
-
Like "Zero" but returns dest. Useful
for encouraging compilers to tail-call
optimise.
void * ZeroD(void* dest, int nitems, type)
Miscellaneous Functions
- dump_c_backtrace
-
Dumps the C backtrace to the given fp.
Returns true if a backtrace could be retrieved, false if not.
bool dump_c_backtrace(PerlIO* fp, int max_depth, int skip)
- fbm_compile
-
Analyses the string in order to make fast searches on it using fbm_instr()
--- the Boyer-Moore algorithm.
void fbm_compile(SV* sv, U32 flags)
- fbm_instr
-
Returns the location of the SV in the string delimited by "big" and
"bigend". It returns "NULL" if the string can't be found. The "sv"
does not have to be fbm_compiled, but the search will not be as fast
then.
char* fbm_instr(unsigned char* big, unsigned char* bigend, SV* littlestr, U32 flags)
- foldEQ
-
Returns true if the leading len bytes of the strings s1 and s2 are the same
case-insensitively; false otherwise. Uppercase and lowercase ASCII range bytes
match themselves and their opposite case counterparts. Non-cased and non-ASCII
range bytes match only themselves.
I32 foldEQ(const char* a, const char* b, I32 len)
- foldEQ_locale
-
Returns true if the leading len bytes of the strings s1 and s2 are the same
case-insensitively in the current locale; false otherwise.
I32 foldEQ_locale(const char* a, const char* b, I32 len)
- form
-
Takes a sprintf-style format pattern and conventional
(non-SV) arguments and returns the formatted string.
(char *) Perl_form(pTHX_ const char* pat, ...)
can be used any place a string (char *) is required:
char * s = Perl_form("%d.%d",major,minor);
Uses a single private buffer so if you want to format several strings you must explicitly copy the earlier strings away (and free the copies when you are done).
char* form(const char* pat, ...)
- getcwd_sv
-
Fill the sv with current working directory
int getcwd_sv(SV* sv)
- get_c_backtrace_dump
-
Returns a SV a dump of |depth| frames of the call stack, skipping
the |skip| innermost ones. depth of 20 is usually enough.
The appended output looks like:
... 1 10e004812:0082 Perl_croak util.c:1716 /usr/bin/perl 2 10df8d6d2:1d72 perl_parse perl.c:3975 /usr/bin/perl ...
The fields are tab-separated. The first column is the depth (zero being the innermost non-skipped frame). In the hex:offset, the hex is where the program counter was in S_parse_body, and the :offset (might be missing) tells how much inside the S_parse_body the program counter was.
The util.c:1716 is the source code file and line number.
The /usr/bin/perl is obvious (hopefully).
Unknowns are "-". Unknowns can happen unfortunately quite easily: if the platform doesn't support retrieving the information; if the binary is missing the debug information; if the optimizer has transformed the code by for example inlining.
SV* get_c_backtrace_dump(int max_depth, int skip)
- ibcmp
-
This is a synonym for (! foldEQ())
I32 ibcmp(const char* a, const char* b, I32 len)
- ibcmp_locale
-
This is a synonym for (! foldEQ_locale())
I32 ibcmp_locale(const char* a, const char* b, I32 len)
- is_safe_syscall
-
Test that the given "pv" doesn't contain any internal "NUL" characters.
If it does, set "errno" to ENOENT, optionally warn, and return FALSE.
Return TRUE if the name is safe.
Used by the IS_SAFE_SYSCALL() macro.
bool is_safe_syscall(const char *pv, STRLEN len, const char *what, const char *op_name)
- memEQ
-
Test two buffers (which may contain embedded "NUL" characters, to see if they
are equal. The "len" parameter indicates the number of bytes to compare.
Returns zero if equal, or non-zero if non-equal.
bool memEQ(char* s1, char* s2, STRLEN len)
- memNE
-
Test two buffers (which may contain embedded "NUL" characters, to see if they
are not equal. The "len" parameter indicates the number of bytes to compare.
Returns zero if non-equal, or non-zero if equal.
bool memNE(char* s1, char* s2, STRLEN len)
- mess
-
Take a sprintf-style format pattern and argument list. These are used to
generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline,
then it will be extended with some indication of the current location
in the code, as described for ``mess_sv''.
Normally, the resulting message is returned in a new mortal SV. During global destruction a single SV may be shared between uses of this function.
SV * mess(const char *pat, ...)
- mess_sv
-
Expands a message, intended for the user, to include an indication of
the current location in the code, if the message does not already appear
to be complete.
"basemsg" is the initial message or object. If it is a reference, it will be used as-is and will be the result of this function. Otherwise it is used as a string, and if it already ends with a newline, it is taken to be complete, and the result of this function will be the same string. If the message does not end with a newline, then a segment such as "at foo.pl line 37" will be appended, and possibly other clauses indicating the current state of execution. The resulting message will end with a dot and a newline.
Normally, the resulting message is returned in a new mortal SV. During global destruction a single SV may be shared between uses of this function. If "consume" is true, then the function is permitted (but not required) to modify and return "basemsg" instead of allocating a new SV.
SV * mess_sv(SV *basemsg, bool consume)
- my_snprintf
-
The C library "snprintf" functionality, if available and
standards-compliant (uses "vsnprintf", actually). However, if the
"vsnprintf" is not available, will unfortunately use the unsafe
"vsprintf" which can overrun the buffer (there is an overrun check,
but that may be too late). Consider using "sv_vcatpvf" instead, or
getting "vsnprintf".
int my_snprintf(char *buffer, const Size_t len, const char *format, ...)
- my_sprintf
-
The C library "sprintf", wrapped if necessary, to ensure that it will return
the length of the string written to the buffer. Only rare pre-ANSI systems
need the wrapper function - usually this is a direct call to "sprintf".
int my_sprintf(char *buffer, const char *pat, ...)
- my_strlcat
-
The C library "strlcat" if available, or a Perl implementation of it.
This operates on C "NUL"-terminated strings.
"my_strlcat()" appends string "src" to the end of "dst". It will append at most "size - strlen(dst) - 1" characters. It will then "NUL"-terminate, unless "size" is 0 or the original "dst" string was longer than "size" (in practice this should not happen as it means that either "size" is incorrect or that "dst" is not a proper "NUL"-terminated string).
Note that "size" is the full size of the destination buffer and the result is guaranteed to be "NUL"-terminated if there is room. Note that room for the "NUL" should be included in "size".
Size_t my_strlcat(char *dst, const char *src, Size_t size)
- my_strlcpy
-
The C library "strlcpy" if available, or a Perl implementation of it.
This operates on C "NUL"-terminated strings.
"my_strlcpy()" copies up to "size - 1" characters from the string "src" to "dst", "NUL"-terminating the result if "size" is not 0.
Size_t my_strlcpy(char *dst, const char *src, Size_t size)
- my_vsnprintf
-
The C library "vsnprintf" if available and standards-compliant.
However, if if the "vsnprintf" is not available, will unfortunately
use the unsafe "vsprintf" which can overrun the buffer (there is an
overrun check, but that may be too late). Consider using
"sv_vcatpvf" instead, or getting "vsnprintf".
int my_vsnprintf(char *buffer, const Size_t len, const char *format, va_list ap)
- PERL_SYS_INIT
-
Provides system-specific tune up of the C runtime environment necessary to
run Perl interpreters. This should be called only once, before creating
any Perl interpreters.
void PERL_SYS_INIT(int *argc, char*** argv)
- PERL_SYS_INIT3
-
Provides system-specific tune up of the C runtime environment necessary to
run Perl interpreters. This should be called only once, before creating
any Perl interpreters.
void PERL_SYS_INIT3(int *argc, char*** argv, char*** env)
- PERL_SYS_TERM
-
Provides system-specific clean up of the C runtime environment after
running Perl interpreters. This should be called only once, after
freeing any remaining Perl interpreters.
void PERL_SYS_TERM()
- quadmath_format_needed
-
quadmath_format_needed() returns true if the format string seems to
contain at least one non-Q-prefixed %[efgaEFGA] format specifier,
or returns false otherwise.
The format specifier detection is not complete printf-syntax detection, but it should catch most common cases.
If true is returned, those arguments should in theory be processed with quadmath_snprintf(), but in case there is more than one such format specifier (see ``quadmath_format_single''), and if there is anything else beyond that one (even just a single byte), they cannot be processed because quadmath_snprintf() is very strict, accepting only one format spec, and nothing else. In this case, the code should probably fail.
bool quadmath_format_needed(const char* format)
- quadmath_format_single
-
quadmath_snprintf() is very strict about its format string and will
fail, returning -1, if the format is invalid. It acccepts exactly
one format spec.
quadmath_format_single() checks that the intended single spec looks sane: begins with "%", has only one "%", ends with "[efgaEFGA]", and has "Q" before it. This is not a full ``printf syntax check'', just the basics.
Returns the format if it is valid, NULL if not.
quadmath_format_single() can and will actually patch in the missing "Q", if necessary. In this case it will return the modified copy of the format, which the caller will need to free.
See also ``quadmath_format_needed''.
const char* quadmath_format_single(const char* format)
- READ_XDIGIT
-
Returns the value of an ASCII-range hex digit and advances the string pointer.
Behaviour is only well defined when isXDIGIT(*str) is true.
U8 READ_XDIGIT(char str*)
- strEQ
-
Test two strings to see if they are equal. Returns true or false.
bool strEQ(char* s1, char* s2)
- strGE
-
Test two strings to see if the first, "s1", is greater than or equal to
the second, "s2". Returns true or false.
bool strGE(char* s1, char* s2)
- strGT
-
Test two strings to see if the first, "s1", is greater than the second,
"s2". Returns true or false.
bool strGT(char* s1, char* s2)
- strLE
-
Test two strings to see if the first, "s1", is less than or equal to the
second, "s2". Returns true or false.
bool strLE(char* s1, char* s2)
- strLT
-
Test two strings to see if the first, "s1", is less than the second,
"s2". Returns true or false.
bool strLT(char* s1, char* s2)
- strNE
-
Test two strings to see if they are different. Returns true or
false.
bool strNE(char* s1, char* s2)
- strnEQ
-
Test two strings to see if they are equal. The "len" parameter indicates
the number of bytes to compare. Returns true or false. (A wrapper for
"strncmp").
bool strnEQ(char* s1, char* s2, STRLEN len)
- strnNE
-
Test two strings to see if they are different. The "len" parameter
indicates the number of bytes to compare. Returns true or false. (A
wrapper for "strncmp").
bool strnNE(char* s1, char* s2, STRLEN len)
- sv_destroyable
-
Dummy routine which reports that object can be destroyed when there is no
sharing module present. It ignores its single SV argument, and returns
'true'. Exists to avoid test for a NULL function pointer and because it
could potentially warn under some level of strict-ness.
bool sv_destroyable(SV *sv)
- sv_nosharing
-
Dummy routine which ``shares'' an SV when there is no sharing module present.
Or ``locks'' it. Or ``unlocks'' it. In other
words, ignores its single SV argument.
Exists to avoid test for a NULL function pointer and because it could
potentially warn under some level of strict-ness.
void sv_nosharing(SV *sv)
- vmess
-
"pat" and "args" are a sprintf-style format pattern and encapsulated
argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the
message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with
some indication of the current location in the code, as described for
``mess_sv''.
Normally, the resulting message is returned in a new mortal SV. During global destruction a single SV may be shared between uses of this function.
SV * vmess(const char *pat, va_list *args)
MRO Functions
These functions are related to the method resolution order of perl classes- mro_get_linear_isa
-
Returns the mro linearisation for the given stash. By default, this
will be whatever "mro_get_linear_isa_dfs" returns unless some
other MRO is in effect for the stash. The return value is a
read-only AV*.
You are responsible for "SvREFCNT_inc()" on the return value if you plan to store it anywhere semi-permanently (otherwise it might be deleted out from under you the next time the cache is invalidated).
AV* mro_get_linear_isa(HV* stash)
- mro_method_changed_in
-
Invalidates method caching on any child classes
of the given stash, so that they might notice
the changes in this one.
Ideally, all instances of "PL_sub_generation++" in perl source outside of mro.c should be replaced by calls to this.
Perl automatically handles most of the common ways a method might be redefined. However, there are a few ways you could change a method in a stash without the cache code noticing, in which case you need to call this method afterwards:
1) Directly manipulating the stash HV entries from XS code.
2) Assigning a reference to a readonly scalar constant into a stash entry in order to create a constant subroutine (like constant.pm does).
This same method is available from pure perl via, "mro::method_changed_in(classname)".
void mro_method_changed_in(HV* stash)
- mro_register
-
Registers a custom mro plugin. See perlmroapi for details.
void mro_register(const struct mro_alg *mro)
Multicall Functions
- dMULTICALL
-
Declare local variables for a multicall. See ``LIGHTWEIGHT CALLBACKS'' in perlcall.
dMULTICALL;
- MULTICALL
-
Make a lightweight callback. See ``LIGHTWEIGHT CALLBACKS'' in perlcall.
MULTICALL;
- POP_MULTICALL
-
Closing bracket for a lightweight callback.
See ``LIGHTWEIGHT CALLBACKS'' in perlcall.
POP_MULTICALL;
- PUSH_MULTICALL
-
Opening bracket for a lightweight callback.
See ``LIGHTWEIGHT CALLBACKS'' in perlcall.
PUSH_MULTICALL;
Numeric functions
- grok_bin
-
converts a string representing a binary number to numeric form.
On entry start and *len give the string to scan, *flags gives conversion flags, and result should be NULL or a pointer to an NV. The scan stops at the end of the string, or the first invalid character. Unless "PERL_SCAN_SILENT_ILLDIGIT" is set in *flags, encountering an invalid character will also trigger a warning. On return *len is set to the length of the scanned string, and *flags gives output flags.
If the value is <= "UV_MAX" it is returned as a UV, the output flags are clear, and nothing is written to *result. If the value is > UV_MAX "grok_bin" returns UV_MAX, sets "PERL_SCAN_GREATER_THAN_UV_MAX" in the output flags, and writes the value to *result (or the value is discarded if result is NULL).
The binary number may optionally be prefixed with ``0b'' or ``b'' unless "PERL_SCAN_DISALLOW_PREFIX" is set in *flags on entry. If "PERL_SCAN_ALLOW_UNDERSCORES" is set in *flags then the binary number may use '_' characters to separate digits.
UV grok_bin(const char* start, STRLEN* len_p, I32* flags, NV *result)
- grok_hex
-
converts a string representing a hex number to numeric form.
On entry start and *len_p give the string to scan, *flags gives conversion flags, and result should be NULL or a pointer to an NV. The scan stops at the end of the string, or the first invalid character. Unless "PERL_SCAN_SILENT_ILLDIGIT" is set in *flags, encountering an invalid character will also trigger a warning. On return *len is set to the length of the scanned string, and *flags gives output flags.
If the value is <= UV_MAX it is returned as a UV, the output flags are clear, and nothing is written to *result. If the value is > UV_MAX "grok_hex" returns UV_MAX, sets "PERL_SCAN_GREATER_THAN_UV_MAX" in the output flags, and writes the value to *result (or the value is discarded if result is NULL).
The hex number may optionally be prefixed with ``0x'' or ``x'' unless "PERL_SCAN_DISALLOW_PREFIX" is set in *flags on entry. If "PERL_SCAN_ALLOW_UNDERSCORES" is set in *flags then the hex number may use '_' characters to separate digits.
UV grok_hex(const char* start, STRLEN* len_p, I32* flags, NV *result)
- grok_infnan
-
Helper for grok_number(), accepts various ways of spelling ``infinity''
or ``not a number'', and returns one of the following flag combinations:
IS_NUMBER_INFINITE IS_NUMBER_NAN IS_NUMBER_INFINITE | IS_NUMBER_NEG IS_NUMBER_NAN | IS_NUMBER_NEG 0
possibly |-ed with IS_NUMBER_TRAILING.
If an infinity or a not-a-number is recognized, the *sp will point to one byte past the end of the recognized string. If the recognition fails, zero is returned, and the *sp will not move.
int grok_infnan(const char** sp, const char *send)
- grok_number
-
Identical to grok_number_flags() with flags set to zero.
int grok_number(const char *pv, STRLEN len, UV *valuep)
- grok_number_flags
-
Recognise (or not) a number. The type of the number is returned
(0 if unrecognised), otherwise it is a bit-ORed combination of
IS_NUMBER_IN_UV, IS_NUMBER_GREATER_THAN_UV_MAX, IS_NUMBER_NOT_INT,
IS_NUMBER_NEG, IS_NUMBER_INFINITY, IS_NUMBER_NAN (defined in perl.h).
If the value of the number can fit in a UV, it is returned in the *valuep IS_NUMBER_IN_UV will be set to indicate that *valuep is valid, IS_NUMBER_IN_UV will never be set unless *valuep is valid, but *valuep may have been assigned to during processing even though IS_NUMBER_IN_UV is not set on return. If valuep is NULL, IS_NUMBER_IN_UV will be set for the same cases as when valuep is non-NULL, but no actual assignment (or SEGV) will occur.
IS_NUMBER_NOT_INT will be set with IS_NUMBER_IN_UV if trailing decimals were seen (in which case *valuep gives the true value truncated to an integer), and IS_NUMBER_NEG if the number is negative (in which case *valuep holds the absolute value). IS_NUMBER_IN_UV is not set if e notation was used or the number is larger than a UV.
"flags" allows only "PERL_SCAN_TRAILING", which allows for trailing non-numeric text on an otherwise successful grok, setting "IS_NUMBER_TRAILING" on the result.
int grok_number_flags(const char *pv, STRLEN len, UV *valuep, U32 flags)
- grok_numeric_radix
-
Scan and skip for a numeric decimal separator (radix).
bool grok_numeric_radix(const char **sp, const char *send)
- grok_oct
-
converts a string representing an octal number to numeric form.
On entry start and *len give the string to scan, *flags gives conversion flags, and result should be NULL or a pointer to an NV. The scan stops at the end of the string, or the first invalid character. Unless "PERL_SCAN_SILENT_ILLDIGIT" is set in *flags, encountering an 8 or 9 will also trigger a warning. On return *len is set to the length of the scanned string, and *flags gives output flags.
If the value is <= UV_MAX it is returned as a UV, the output flags are clear, and nothing is written to *result. If the value is > UV_MAX "grok_oct" returns UV_MAX, sets "PERL_SCAN_GREATER_THAN_UV_MAX" in the output flags, and writes the value to *result (or the value is discarded if result is NULL).
If "PERL_SCAN_ALLOW_UNDERSCORES" is set in *flags then the octal number may use '_' characters to separate digits.
UV grok_oct(const char* start, STRLEN* len_p, I32* flags, NV *result)
- isinfnan
-
Perl_isinfnan() is utility function that returns true if the NV
argument is either an infinity or a NaN, false otherwise. To test
in more detail, use Perl_isinf() and Perl_isnan().
This is also the logical inverse of Perl_isfinite().
bool isinfnan(NV nv)
- Perl_signbit
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Return a non-zero integer if the sign bit on an NV is set, and 0 if it is not.
If Configure detects this system has a signbit() that will work with our NVs, then we just use it via the #define in perl.h. Otherwise, fall back on this implementation. The main use of this function is catching -0.0.
Configure notes: This function is called 'Perl_signbit' instead of a plain 'signbit' because it is easy to imagine a system having a signbit() function or macro that doesn't happen to work with our particular choice of NVs. We shouldn't just re-#define signbit as Perl_signbit and expect the standard system headers to be happy. Also, this is a no-context function (no pTHX_) because Perl_signbit() is usually re-#defined in perl.h as a simple macro call to the system's signbit(). Users should just always call Perl_signbit().
int Perl_signbit(NV f)
- scan_bin
-
For backwards compatibility. Use "grok_bin" instead.
NV scan_bin(const char* start, STRLEN len, STRLEN* retlen)
- scan_hex
-
For backwards compatibility. Use "grok_hex" instead.
NV scan_hex(const char* start, STRLEN len, STRLEN* retlen)
- scan_oct
-
For backwards compatibility. Use "grok_oct" instead.
NV scan_oct(const char* start, STRLEN len, STRLEN* retlen)
Obsolete backwards compatibility functions
Some of these are also deprecated. You can exclude these from your compiled Perl by adding this option to Configure: "-Accflags='-DNO_MATHOMS'"- custom_op_desc
-
Return the description of a given custom op. This was once used by the
OP_DESC macro, but is no longer: it has only been kept for
compatibility, and should not be used.
const char * custom_op_desc(const OP *o)
- custom_op_name
-
Return the name for a given custom op. This was once used by the OP_NAME
macro, but is no longer: it has only been kept for compatibility, and
should not be used.
const char * custom_op_name(const OP *o)
- gv_fetchmethod
-
See ``gv_fetchmethod_autoload''.
GV* gv_fetchmethod(HV* stash, const char* name)
- is_utf8_char
-
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a
future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from
existing code.
Tests if some arbitrary number of bytes begins in a valid UTF-8 character. Note that an INVARIANT (i.e. ASCII on non-EBCDIC machines) character is a valid UTF-8 character. The actual number of bytes in the UTF-8 character will be returned if it is valid, otherwise 0.
This function is deprecated due to the possibility that malformed input could cause reading beyond the end of the input buffer. Use ``isUTF8_CHAR'' instead.
STRLEN is_utf8_char(const U8 *s)
- is_utf8_char_buf
-
This is identical to the macro ``isUTF8_CHAR''.
STRLEN is_utf8_char_buf(const U8 *buf, const U8 *buf_end)
- pack_cat
-
The engine implementing pack() Perl function. Note: parameters
next_in_list and flags are not used. This call should not be used; use
packlist instead.
void pack_cat(SV *cat, const char *pat, const char *patend, SV **beglist, SV **endlist, SV ***next_in_list, U32 flags)
- pad_compname_type
-
Looks up the type of the lexical variable at position po in the
currently-compiling pad. If the variable is typed, the stash of the
class to which it is typed is returned. If not, "NULL" is returned.
HV * pad_compname_type(PADOFFSET po)
- sv_2pvbyte_nolen
-
Return a pointer to the byte-encoded representation of the SV.
May cause the SV to be downgraded from UTF-8 as a side-effect.
Usually accessed via the "SvPVbyte_nolen" macro.
char* sv_2pvbyte_nolen(SV* sv)
- sv_2pvutf8_nolen
-
Return a pointer to the UTF-8-encoded representation of the SV.
May cause the SV to be upgraded to UTF-8 as a side-effect.
Usually accessed via the "SvPVutf8_nolen" macro.
char* sv_2pvutf8_nolen(SV* sv)
- sv_2pv_nolen
-
Like "sv_2pv()", but doesn't return the length too. You should usually
use the macro wrapper "SvPV_nolen(sv)" instead.
char* sv_2pv_nolen(SV* sv)
- sv_catpvn_mg
-
Like "sv_catpvn", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_catpvn_mg(SV *sv, const char *ptr, STRLEN len)
- sv_catsv_mg
-
Like "sv_catsv", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_catsv_mg(SV *dsv, SV *ssv)
- sv_force_normal
-
Undo various types of fakery on an SV: if the PV is a shared string, make
a private copy; if we're a ref, stop refing; if we're a glob, downgrade to
an xpvmg. See also "sv_force_normal_flags".
void sv_force_normal(SV *sv)
- sv_iv
-
A private implementation of the "SvIVx" macro for compilers which can't
cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
IV sv_iv(SV* sv)
- sv_nolocking
-
Dummy routine which ``locks'' an SV when there is no locking module present.
Exists to avoid test for a NULL function pointer and because it could
potentially warn under some level of strict-ness.
``Superseded'' by sv_nosharing().
void sv_nolocking(SV *sv)
- sv_nounlocking
-
Dummy routine which ``unlocks'' an SV when there is no locking module present.
Exists to avoid test for a NULL function pointer and because it could
potentially warn under some level of strict-ness.
``Superseded'' by sv_nosharing().
void sv_nounlocking(SV *sv)
- sv_nv
-
A private implementation of the "SvNVx" macro for compilers which can't
cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
NV sv_nv(SV* sv)
- sv_pv
-
Use the "SvPV_nolen" macro instead
char* sv_pv(SV *sv)
- sv_pvbyte
-
Use "SvPVbyte_nolen" instead.
char* sv_pvbyte(SV *sv)
- sv_pvbyten
-
A private implementation of the "SvPVbyte" macro for compilers
which can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro
instead.
char* sv_pvbyten(SV *sv, STRLEN *lp)
- sv_pvn
-
A private implementation of the "SvPV" macro for compilers which can't
cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
char* sv_pvn(SV *sv, STRLEN *lp)
- sv_pvutf8
-
Use the "SvPVutf8_nolen" macro instead
char* sv_pvutf8(SV *sv)
- sv_pvutf8n
-
A private implementation of the "SvPVutf8" macro for compilers
which can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro
instead.
char* sv_pvutf8n(SV *sv, STRLEN *lp)
- sv_taint
-
Taint an SV. Use "SvTAINTED_on" instead.
void sv_taint(SV* sv)
- sv_unref
-
Unsets the RV status of the SV, and decrements the reference count of
whatever was being referenced by the RV. This can almost be thought of
as a reversal of "newSVrv". This is "sv_unref_flags" with the "flag"
being zero. See "SvROK_off".
void sv_unref(SV* sv)
- sv_usepvn
-
Tells an SV to use "ptr" to find its string value. Implemented by
calling "sv_usepvn_flags" with "flags" of 0, hence does not handle 'set'
magic. See "sv_usepvn_flags".
void sv_usepvn(SV* sv, char* ptr, STRLEN len)
- sv_usepvn_mg
-
Like "sv_usepvn", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_usepvn_mg(SV *sv, char *ptr, STRLEN len)
- sv_uv
-
A private implementation of the "SvUVx" macro for compilers which can't
cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
UV sv_uv(SV* sv)
- unpack_str
-
The engine implementing unpack() Perl function. Note: parameters strbeg,
new_s and ocnt are not used. This call should not be used, use
unpackstring instead.
I32 unpack_str(const char *pat, const char *patend, const char *s, const char *strbeg, const char *strend, char **new_s, I32 ocnt, U32 flags)
- utf8_to_uvchr
-
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a
future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from
existing code.
Returns the native code point of the first character in the string "s" which is assumed to be in UTF-8 encoding; "retlen" will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
Some, but not all, UTF-8 malformations are detected, and in fact, some malformed input could cause reading beyond the end of the input buffer, which is why this function is deprecated. Use ``utf8_to_uvchr_buf'' instead.
If "s" points to one of the detected malformations, and UTF8 warnings are enabled, zero is returned and *retlen is set (if "retlen" isn't NULL) to -1. If those warnings are off, the computed value if well-defined (or the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, if not) is silently returned, and *retlen is set (if "retlen" isn't NULL) so that ("s" + *retlen) is the next possible position in "s" that could begin a non-malformed character. See ``utf8n_to_uvchr'' for details on when the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER is returned.
UV utf8_to_uvchr(const U8 *s, STRLEN *retlen)
- utf8_to_uvuni
-
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a
future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from
existing code.
Returns the Unicode code point of the first character in the string "s" which is assumed to be in UTF-8 encoding; "retlen" will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
Some, but not all, UTF-8 malformations are detected, and in fact, some malformed input could cause reading beyond the end of the input buffer, which is one reason why this function is deprecated. The other is that only in extremely limited circumstances should the Unicode versus native code point be of any interest to you. See ``utf8_to_uvuni_buf'' for alternatives.
If "s" points to one of the detected malformations, and UTF8 warnings are enabled, zero is returned and *retlen is set (if "retlen" doesn't point to NULL) to -1. If those warnings are off, the computed value if well-defined (or the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, if not) is silently returned, and *retlen is set (if "retlen" isn't NULL) so that ("s" + *retlen) is the next possible position in "s" that could begin a non-malformed character. See ``utf8n_to_uvchr'' for details on when the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER is returned.
UV utf8_to_uvuni(const U8 *s, STRLEN *retlen)
Optree construction
- newASSIGNOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an assignment op. left and right
supply the parameters of the assignment; they are consumed by this
function and become part of the constructed op tree.
If optype is "OP_ANDASSIGN", "OP_ORASSIGN", or "OP_DORASSIGN", then a suitable conditional optree is constructed. If optype is the opcode of a binary operator, such as "OP_BIT_OR", then an op is constructed that performs the binary operation and assigns the result to the left argument. Either way, if optype is non-zero then flags has no effect.
If optype is zero, then a plain scalar or list assignment is constructed. Which type of assignment it is is automatically determined. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags", except that "OPf_KIDS" will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of "op_private", except that the bit with value 1 or 2 is automatically set as required.
OP * newASSIGNOP(I32 flags, OP *left, I32 optype, OP *right)
- newBINOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any binary type. type
is the opcode. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags", except
that "OPf_KIDS" will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits,
the eight bits of "op_private", except that the bit with value 1 or
2 is automatically set as required. first and last supply up to
two ops to be the direct children of the binary op; they are consumed
by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newBINOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first, OP *last)
- newCONDOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns a conditional-expression ("cond_expr")
op. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags", except that "OPf_KIDS"
will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of
"op_private", except that the bit with value 1 is automatically set.
first supplies the expression selecting between the two branches,
and trueop and falseop supply the branches; they are consumed by
this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newCONDOP(I32 flags, OP *first, OP *trueop, OP *falseop)
- newDEFSVOP
-
Constructs and returns an op to access $_, either as a lexical
variable (if declared as "my $_") in the current scope, or the
global $_.
OP * newDEFSVOP()
- newFOROP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a "foreach"
loop (iteration through a list of values). This is a heavyweight loop,
with structure that allows exiting the loop by "last" and suchlike.
sv optionally supplies the variable that will be aliased to each item in turn; if null, it defaults to $_ (either lexical or global). expr supplies the list of values to iterate over. block supplies the main body of the loop, and cont optionally supplies a "continue" block that operates as a second half of the body. All of these optree inputs are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags" for the "leaveloop" op and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of "op_private" for the "leaveloop" op, except that (in both cases) some bits will be set automatically.
OP * newFOROP(I32 flags, OP *sv, OP *expr, OP *block, OP *cont)
- newGIVENOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a "given" block.
cond supplies the expression that will be locally assigned to a lexical
variable, and block supplies the body of the "given" construct; they
are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
defsv_off is the pad offset of the scalar lexical variable that will
be affected. If it is 0, the global $_ will be used.
OP * newGIVENOP(OP *cond, OP *block, PADOFFSET defsv_off)
- newGVOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any type that involves an
embedded reference to a GV. type is the opcode. flags gives the
eight bits of "op_flags". gv identifies the GV that the op should
reference; calling this function does not transfer ownership of any
reference to it.
OP * newGVOP(I32 type, I32 flags, GV *gv)
- newLISTOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any list type. type is
the opcode. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags", except that
"OPf_KIDS" will be set automatically if required. first and last
supply up to two ops to be direct children of the list op; they are
consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
For most list operators, the check function expects all the kid ops to be present already, so calling "newLISTOP(OP_JOIN, ...)" (e.g.) is not appropriate. What you want to do in that case is create an op of type OP_LIST, append more children to it, and then call ``op_convert_list''. See ``op_convert_list'' for more information.
OP * newLISTOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first, OP *last)
- newLOGOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns a logical (flow control) op. type
is the opcode. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags", except
that "OPf_KIDS" will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits,
the eight bits of "op_private", except that the bit with value 1 is
automatically set. first supplies the expression controlling the
flow, and other supplies the side (alternate) chain of ops; they are
consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newLOGOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first, OP *other)
- newLOOPEX
-
Constructs, checks, and returns a loop-exiting op (such as "goto"
or "last"). type is the opcode. label supplies the parameter
determining the target of the op; it is consumed by this function and
becomes part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newLOOPEX(I32 type, OP *label)
- newLOOPOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a loop. This is
only a loop in the control flow through the op tree; it does not have
the heavyweight loop structure that allows exiting the loop by "last"
and suchlike. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags" for the
top-level op, except that some bits will be set automatically as required.
expr supplies the expression controlling loop iteration, and block
supplies the body of the loop; they are consumed by this function and
become part of the constructed op tree. debuggable is currently
unused and should always be 1.
OP * newLOOPOP(I32 flags, I32 debuggable, OP *expr, OP *block)
- newMETHOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of method type with a method name
evaluated at runtime. type is the opcode. flags gives the eight
bits of "op_flags", except that "OPf_KIDS" will be set automatically,
and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of "op_private", except that
the bit with value 1 is automatically set. dynamic_meth supplies an
op which evaluates method name; it is consumed by this function and
become part of the constructed op tree.
Supported optypes: OP_METHOD.
OP * newMETHOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first)
- newMETHOP_named
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of method type with a constant
method name. type is the opcode. flags gives the eight bits of
"op_flags", and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of
"op_private". const_meth supplies a constant method name;
it must be a shared COW string.
Supported optypes: OP_METHOD_NAMED.
OP * newMETHOP_named(I32 type, I32 flags, SV *const_meth)
- newNULLLIST
-
Constructs, checks, and returns a new "stub" op, which represents an
empty list expression.
OP * newNULLLIST()
- newOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any base type (any type that
has no extra fields). type is the opcode. flags gives the
eight bits of "op_flags", and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits
of "op_private".
OP * newOP(I32 type, I32 flags)
- newPADOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any type that involves a
reference to a pad element. type is the opcode. flags gives the
eight bits of "op_flags". A pad slot is automatically allocated, and
is populated with sv; this function takes ownership of one reference
to it.
This function only exists if Perl has been compiled to use ithreads.
OP * newPADOP(I32 type, I32 flags, SV *sv)
- newPMOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any pattern matching type.
type is the opcode. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags"
and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of "op_private".
OP * newPMOP(I32 type, I32 flags)
- newPVOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any type that involves an
embedded C-level pointer (PV). type is the opcode. flags gives
the eight bits of "op_flags". pv supplies the C-level pointer, which
must have been allocated using "PerlMemShared_malloc"; the memory will
be freed when the op is destroyed.
OP * newPVOP(I32 type, I32 flags, char *pv)
- newRANGE
-
Constructs and returns a "range" op, with subordinate "flip" and
"flop" ops. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags" for the
"flip" op and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of "op_private"
for both the "flip" and "range" ops, except that the bit with value
1 is automatically set. left and right supply the expressions
controlling the endpoints of the range; they are consumed by this function
and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newRANGE(I32 flags, OP *left, OP *right)
- newSLICEOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an "lslice" (list slice) op. flags
gives the eight bits of "op_flags", except that "OPf_KIDS" will
be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of
"op_private", except that the bit with value 1 or 2 is automatically
set as required. listval and subscript supply the parameters of
the slice; they are consumed by this function and become part of the
constructed op tree.
OP * newSLICEOP(I32 flags, OP *subscript, OP *listval)
- newSTATEOP
-
Constructs a state op (COP). The state op is normally a "nextstate" op,
but will be a "dbstate" op if debugging is enabled for currently-compiled
code. The state op is populated from "PL_curcop" (or "PL_compiling").
If label is non-null, it supplies the name of a label to attach to
the state op; this function takes ownership of the memory pointed at by
label, and will free it. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags"
for the state op.
If o is null, the state op is returned. Otherwise the state op is combined with o into a "lineseq" list op, which is returned. o is consumed by this function and becomes part of the returned op tree.
OP * newSTATEOP(I32 flags, char *label, OP *o)
- newSVOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any type that involves an
embedded SV. type is the opcode. flags gives the eight bits
of "op_flags". sv gives the SV to embed in the op; this function
takes ownership of one reference to it.
OP * newSVOP(I32 type, I32 flags, SV *sv)
- newUNOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any unary type. type is
the opcode. flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags", except that
"OPf_KIDS" will be set automatically if required, and, shifted up eight
bits, the eight bits of "op_private", except that the bit with value 1
is automatically set. first supplies an optional op to be the direct
child of the unary op; it is consumed by this function and become part
of the constructed op tree.
OP * newUNOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first)
- newUNOP_AUX
-
Similar to "newUNOP", but creates an UNOP_AUX struct instead, with op_aux
initialised to aux
OP* newUNOP_AUX(I32 type, I32 flags, OP* first, UNOP_AUX_item *aux)
- newWHENOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a "when" block.
cond supplies the test expression, and block supplies the block
that will be executed if the test evaluates to true; they are consumed
by this function and become part of the constructed op tree. cond
will be interpreted DWIMically, often as a comparison against $_,
and may be null to generate a "default" block.
OP * newWHENOP(OP *cond, OP *block)
- newWHILEOP
-
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a "while" loop.
This is a heavyweight loop, with structure that allows exiting the loop
by "last" and suchlike.
loop is an optional preconstructed "enterloop" op to use in the loop; if it is null then a suitable op will be constructed automatically. expr supplies the loop's controlling expression. block supplies the main body of the loop, and cont optionally supplies a "continue" block that operates as a second half of the body. All of these optree inputs are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
flags gives the eight bits of "op_flags" for the "leaveloop" op and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of "op_private" for the "leaveloop" op, except that (in both cases) some bits will be set automatically. debuggable is currently unused and should always be 1. has_my can be supplied as true to force the loop body to be enclosed in its own scope.
OP * newWHILEOP(I32 flags, I32 debuggable, LOOP *loop, OP *expr, OP *block, OP *cont, I32 has_my)
Optree Manipulation Functions
- alloccopstash
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Available only under threaded builds, this function allocates an entry in "PL_stashpad" for the stash passed to it.
PADOFFSET alloccopstash(HV *hv)
- block_end
-
Handles compile-time scope exit. floor
is the savestack index returned by
"block_start", and seq is the body of the block. Returns the block,
possibly modified.
OP * block_end(I32 floor, OP *seq)
- block_start
-
Handles compile-time scope entry.
Arranges for hints to be restored on block
exit and also handles pad sequence numbers to make lexical variables scope
right. Returns a savestack index for use with "block_end".
int block_start(int full)
- ck_entersub_args_list
-
Performs the default fixup of the arguments part of an "entersub"
op tree. This consists of applying list context to each of the
argument ops. This is the standard treatment used on a call marked
with "&", or a method call, or a call through a subroutine reference,
or any other call where the callee can't be identified at compile time,
or a call where the callee has no prototype.
OP * ck_entersub_args_list(OP *entersubop)
- ck_entersub_args_proto
-
Performs the fixup of the arguments part of an "entersub" op tree
based on a subroutine prototype. This makes various modifications to
the argument ops, from applying context up to inserting "refgen" ops,
and checking the number and syntactic types of arguments, as directed by
the prototype. This is the standard treatment used on a subroutine call,
not marked with "&", where the callee can be identified at compile time
and has a prototype.
protosv supplies the subroutine prototype to be applied to the call. It may be a normal defined scalar, of which the string value will be used. Alternatively, for convenience, it may be a subroutine object (a "CV*" that has been cast to "SV*") which has a prototype. The prototype supplied, in whichever form, does not need to match the actual callee referenced by the op tree.
If the argument ops disagree with the prototype, for example by having an unacceptable number of arguments, a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. In the error message, the callee is referred to by the name defined by the namegv parameter.
OP * ck_entersub_args_proto(OP *entersubop, GV *namegv, SV *protosv)
- ck_entersub_args_proto_or_list
-
Performs the fixup of the arguments part of an "entersub" op tree either
based on a subroutine prototype or using default list-context processing.
This is the standard treatment used on a subroutine call, not marked
with "&", where the callee can be identified at compile time.
protosv supplies the subroutine prototype to be applied to the call, or indicates that there is no prototype. It may be a normal scalar, in which case if it is defined then the string value will be used as a prototype, and if it is undefined then there is no prototype. Alternatively, for convenience, it may be a subroutine object (a "CV*" that has been cast to "SV*"), of which the prototype will be used if it has one. The prototype (or lack thereof) supplied, in whichever form, does not need to match the actual callee referenced by the op tree.
If the argument ops disagree with the prototype, for example by having an unacceptable number of arguments, a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. In the error message, the callee is referred to by the name defined by the namegv parameter.
OP * ck_entersub_args_proto_or_list(OP *entersubop, GV *namegv, SV *protosv)
- cv_const_sv
-
If "cv" is a constant sub eligible for inlining, returns the constant
value returned by the sub. Otherwise, returns NULL.
Constant subs can be created with "newCONSTSUB" or as described in ``Constant Functions'' in perlsub.
SV* cv_const_sv(const CV *const cv)
- cv_get_call_checker
-
Retrieves the function that will be used to fix up a call to cv.
Specifically, the function is applied to an "entersub" op tree for a
subroutine call, not marked with "&", where the callee can be identified
at compile time as cv.
The C-level function pointer is returned in *ckfun_p, and an SV argument for it is returned in *ckobj_p. The function is intended to be called in this manner:
entersubop = (*ckfun_p)(aTHX_ entersubop, namegv, (*ckobj_p));
In this call, entersubop is a pointer to the "entersub" op, which may be replaced by the check function, and namegv is a GV supplying the name that should be used by the check function to refer to the callee of the "entersub" op if it needs to emit any diagnostics. It is permitted to apply the check function in non-standard situations, such as to a call to a different subroutine or to a method call.
By default, the function is Perl_ck_entersub_args_proto_or_list, and the SV parameter is cv itself. This implements standard prototype processing. It can be changed, for a particular subroutine, by ``cv_set_call_checker''.
void cv_get_call_checker(CV *cv, Perl_call_checker *ckfun_p, SV **ckobj_p)
- cv_set_call_checker
-
The original form of ``cv_set_call_checker_flags'', which passes it the
"CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV" flag for backward-compatibility.
void cv_set_call_checker(CV *cv, Perl_call_checker ckfun, SV *ckobj)
- cv_set_call_checker_flags
-
Sets the function that will be used to fix up a call to cv.
Specifically, the function is applied to an "entersub" op tree for a
subroutine call, not marked with "&", where the callee can be identified
at compile time as cv.
The C-level function pointer is supplied in ckfun, and an SV argument for it is supplied in ckobj. The function should be defined like this:
STATIC OP * ckfun(pTHX_ OP *op, GV *namegv, SV *ckobj)
It is intended to be called in this manner:
entersubop = ckfun(aTHX_ entersubop, namegv, ckobj);
In this call, entersubop is a pointer to the "entersub" op, which may be replaced by the check function, and namegv supplies the name that should be used by the check function to refer to the callee of the "entersub" op if it needs to emit any diagnostics. It is permitted to apply the check function in non-standard situations, such as to a call to a different subroutine or to a method call.
namegv may not actually be a GV. For efficiency, perl may pass a CV or other SV instead. Whatever is passed can be used as the first argument to ``cv_name''. You can force perl to pass a GV by including "CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV" in the flags.
The current setting for a particular CV can be retrieved by ``cv_get_call_checker''.
void cv_set_call_checker_flags( CV *cv, Perl_call_checker ckfun, SV *ckobj, U32 flags )
- LINKLIST
-
Given the root of an optree, link the tree in execution order using the
"op_next" pointers and return the first op executed. If this has
already been done, it will not be redone, and "o->op_next" will be
returned. If "o->op_next" is not already set, o should be at
least an "UNOP".
OP* LINKLIST(OP *o)
- newCONSTSUB
-
See ``newCONSTSUB_flags''.
CV* newCONSTSUB(HV* stash, const char* name, SV* sv)
- newCONSTSUB_flags
-
Creates a constant sub equivalent to Perl "sub FOO () { 123 }" which is
eligible for inlining at compile-time.
Currently, the only useful value for "flags" is SVf_UTF8.
The newly created subroutine takes ownership of a reference to the passed in SV.
Passing NULL for SV creates a constant sub equivalent to "sub BAR () {}", which won't be called if used as a destructor, but will suppress the overhead of a call to "AUTOLOAD". (This form, however, isn't eligible for inlining at compile time.)
CV* newCONSTSUB_flags(HV* stash, const char* name, STRLEN len, U32 flags, SV* sv)
- newXS
- Used by "xsubpp" to hook up XSUBs as Perl subs. filename needs to be static storage, as it is used directly as CvFILE(), without a copy being made.
- OpHAS_SIBLING
-
Returns true if o has a sibling
bool OpHAS_SIBLING(OP *o)
- OpLASTSIB_set
-
Marks o as having no further siblings. On "PERL_OP_PARENT" builds, marks
o as having the specified parent. See also "OpMORESIB_set" and
"OpMAYBESIB_set". For a higher-level interface, see
"op_sibling_splice".
void OpLASTSIB_set(OP *o, OP *parent)
- OpMAYBESIB_set
-
Conditionally does "OpMORESIB_set" or "OpLASTSIB_set" depending on whether
sib is non-null. For a higher-level interface, see "op_sibling_splice".
void OpMAYBESIB_set(OP *o, OP *sib, OP *parent)
- OpMORESIB_set
-
Sets the sibling of o to the non-zero value sib. See also "OpLASTSIB_set"
and "OpMAYBESIB_set". For a higher-level interface, see
"op_sibling_splice".
void OpMORESIB_set(OP *o, OP *sib)
- OpSIBLING
-
Returns the sibling of o, or NULL if there is no sibling
OP* OpSIBLING(OP *o)
- op_append_elem
-
Append an item to the list of ops contained directly within a list-type
op, returning the lengthened list. first is the list-type op,
and last is the op to append to the list. optype specifies the
intended opcode for the list. If first is not already a list of the
right type, it will be upgraded into one. If either first or last
is null, the other is returned unchanged.
OP * op_append_elem(I32 optype, OP *first, OP *last)
- op_append_list
-
Concatenate the lists of ops contained directly within two list-type ops,
returning the combined list. first and last are the list-type ops
to concatenate. optype specifies the intended opcode for the list.
If either first or last is not already a list of the right type,
it will be upgraded into one. If either first or last is null,
the other is returned unchanged.
OP * op_append_list(I32 optype, OP *first, OP *last)
- OP_CLASS
-
Return the class of the provided OP: that is, which of the *OP
structures it uses. For core ops this currently gets the information out
of PL_opargs, which does not always accurately reflect the type used.
For custom ops the type is returned from the registration, and it is up
to the registree to ensure it is accurate. The value returned will be
one of the OA_* constants from op.h.
U32 OP_CLASS(OP *o)
- op_contextualize
-
Applies a syntactic context to an op tree representing an expression.
o is the op tree, and context must be "G_SCALAR", "G_ARRAY",
or "G_VOID" to specify the context to apply. The modified op tree
is returned.
OP * op_contextualize(OP *o, I32 context)
- op_convert_list
-
Converts o into a list op if it is not one already, and then converts it
into the specified type, calling its check function, allocating a target if
it needs one, and folding constants.
A list-type op is usually constructed one kid at a time via "newLISTOP", "op_prepend_elem" and "op_append_elem". Then finally it is passed to "op_convert_list" to make it the right type.
OP * op_convert_list(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *o)
- OP_DESC
-
Return a short description of the provided OP.
const char * OP_DESC(OP *o)
- op_free
-
Free an op. Only use this when an op is no longer linked to from any
optree.
void op_free(OP *o)
- op_linklist
-
This function is the implementation of the ``LINKLIST'' macro. It should
not be called directly.
OP* op_linklist(OP *o)
- op_lvalue
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Propagate lvalue (``modifiable'') context to an op and its children. type represents the context type, roughly based on the type of op that would do the modifying, although "local()" is represented by OP_NULL, because it has no op type of its own (it is signalled by a flag on the lvalue op).
This function detects things that can't be modified, such as "$x+1", and generates errors for them. For example, "$x+1 = 2" would cause it to be called with an op of type OP_ADD and a "type" argument of OP_SASSIGN.
It also flags things that need to behave specially in an lvalue context, such as "$$x = 5" which might have to vivify a reference in $x.
OP * op_lvalue(OP *o, I32 type)
- OP_NAME
-
Return the name of the provided OP. For core ops this looks up the name
from the op_type; for custom ops from the op_ppaddr.
const char * OP_NAME(OP *o)
- op_null
-
Neutralizes an op when it is no longer needed, but is still linked to from
other ops.
void op_null(OP *o)
- op_parent
-
Returns the parent OP of o, if it has a parent. Returns NULL otherwise.
This function is only available on perls built with "-DPERL_OP_PARENT".
OP* op_parent(OP *o)
- op_prepend_elem
-
Prepend an item to the list of ops contained directly within a list-type
op, returning the lengthened list. first is the op to prepend to the
list, and last is the list-type op. optype specifies the intended
opcode for the list. If last is not already a list of the right type,
it will be upgraded into one. If either first or last is null,
the other is returned unchanged.
OP * op_prepend_elem(I32 optype, OP *first, OP *last)
- op_scope
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Wraps up an op tree with some additional ops so that at runtime a dynamic scope will be created. The original ops run in the new dynamic scope, and then, provided that they exit normally, the scope will be unwound. The additional ops used to create and unwind the dynamic scope will normally be an "enter"/"leave" pair, but a "scope" op may be used instead if the ops are simple enough to not need the full dynamic scope structure.
OP * op_scope(OP *o)
- op_sibling_splice
-
A general function for editing the structure of an existing chain of
op_sibling nodes. By analogy with the perl-level splice() function, allows
you to delete zero or more sequential nodes, replacing them with zero or
more different nodes. Performs the necessary op_first/op_last
housekeeping on the parent node and op_sibling manipulation on the
children. The last deleted node will be marked as as the last node by
updating the op_sibling/op_sibparent or op_moresib field as appropriate.
Note that op_next is not manipulated, and nodes are not freed; that is the responsibility of the caller. It also won't create a new list op for an empty list etc; use higher-level functions like op_append_elem() for that.
parent is the parent node of the sibling chain. It may passed as NULL if the splicing doesn't affect the first or last op in the chain.
start is the node preceding the first node to be spliced. Node(s) following it will be deleted, and ops will be inserted after it. If it is NULL, the first node onwards is deleted, and nodes are inserted at the beginning.
del_count is the number of nodes to delete. If zero, no nodes are deleted. If -1 or greater than or equal to the number of remaining kids, all remaining kids are deleted.
insert is the first of a chain of nodes to be inserted in place of the nodes. If NULL, no nodes are inserted.
The head of the chain of deleted ops is returned, or NULL if no ops were deleted.
For example:
action before after returns ------ ----- ----- ------- P P splice(P, A, 2, X-Y-Z) | | B-C A-B-C-D A-X-Y-Z-D P P splice(P, NULL, 1, X-Y) | | A A-B-C-D X-Y-B-C-D P P splice(P, NULL, 3, NULL) | | A-B-C A-B-C-D D P P splice(P, B, 0, X-Y) | | NULL A-B-C-D A-B-X-Y-C-D
For lower-level direct manipulation of "op_sibparent" and "op_moresib", see "OpMORESIB_set", "OpLASTSIB_set", "OpMAYBESIB_set".
OP* op_sibling_splice(OP *parent, OP *start, int del_count, OP* insert)
- OP_TYPE_IS
-
Returns true if the given OP is not a NULL pointer
and if it is of the given type.
The negation of this macro, "OP_TYPE_ISNT" is also available as well as "OP_TYPE_IS_NN" and "OP_TYPE_ISNT_NN" which elide the NULL pointer check.
bool OP_TYPE_IS(OP *o, Optype type)
- OP_TYPE_IS_OR_WAS
-
Returns true if the given OP is not a NULL pointer and
if it is of the given type or used to be before being
replaced by an OP of type OP_NULL.
The negation of this macro, "OP_TYPE_ISNT_AND_WASNT" is also available as well as "OP_TYPE_IS_OR_WAS_NN" and "OP_TYPE_ISNT_AND_WASNT_NN" which elide the NULL pointer check.
bool OP_TYPE_IS_OR_WAS(OP *o, Optype type)
- rv2cv_op_cv
-
Examines an op, which is expected to identify a subroutine at runtime,
and attempts to determine at compile time which subroutine it identifies.
This is normally used during Perl compilation to determine whether
a prototype can be applied to a function call. cvop is the op
being considered, normally an "rv2cv" op. A pointer to the identified
subroutine is returned, if it could be determined statically, and a null
pointer is returned if it was not possible to determine statically.
Currently, the subroutine can be identified statically if the RV that the "rv2cv" is to operate on is provided by a suitable "gv" or "const" op. A "gv" op is suitable if the GV's CV slot is populated. A "const" op is suitable if the constant value must be an RV pointing to a CV. Details of this process may change in future versions of Perl. If the "rv2cv" op has the "OPpENTERSUB_AMPER" flag set then no attempt is made to identify the subroutine statically: this flag is used to suppress compile-time magic on a subroutine call, forcing it to use default runtime behaviour.
If flags has the bit "RV2CVOPCV_MARK_EARLY" set, then the handling of a GV reference is modified. If a GV was examined and its CV slot was found to be empty, then the "gv" op has the "OPpEARLY_CV" flag set. If the op is not optimised away, and the CV slot is later populated with a subroutine having a prototype, that flag eventually triggers the warning ``called too early to check prototype''.
If flags has the bit "RV2CVOPCV_RETURN_NAME_GV" set, then instead of returning a pointer to the subroutine it returns a pointer to the GV giving the most appropriate name for the subroutine in this context. Normally this is just the "CvGV" of the subroutine, but for an anonymous ("CvANON") subroutine that is referenced through a GV it will be the referencing GV. The resulting "GV*" is cast to "CV*" to be returned. A null pointer is returned as usual if there is no statically-determinable subroutine.
CV * rv2cv_op_cv(OP *cvop, U32 flags)
Pack and Unpack
- packlist
-
The engine implementing pack() Perl function.
void packlist(SV *cat, const char *pat, const char *patend, SV **beglist, SV **endlist)
- unpackstring
-
The engine implementing the unpack() Perl function.
Using the template pat..patend, this function unpacks the string s..strend into a number of mortal SVs, which it pushes onto the perl argument (@_) stack (so you will need to issue a "PUTBACK" before and "SPAGAIN" after the call to this function). It returns the number of pushed elements.
The strend and patend pointers should point to the byte following the last character of each string.
Although this function returns its values on the perl argument stack, it doesn't take any parameters from that stack (and thus in particular there's no need to do a PUSHMARK before calling it, unlike ``call_pv'' for example).
I32 unpackstring(const char *pat, const char *patend, const char *s, const char *strend, U32 flags)
Pad Data Structures
- CvPADLIST
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
CV's can have CvPADLIST(cv) set to point to a PADLIST. This is the CV's scratchpad, which stores lexical variables and opcode temporary and per-thread values.
For these purposes ``formats'' are a kind-of CV; eval"``s are too (except they're not callable at will and are always thrown away after the eval''" is done executing). Require'd files are simply evals without any outer lexical scope.
XSUBs do not have a CvPADLIST. dXSTARG fetches values from PL_curpad, but that is really the callers pad (a slot of which is allocated by every entersub). Do not get or set CvPADLIST if a CV is an XSUB (as determined by "CvISXSUB()"), CvPADLIST slot is reused for a different internal purpose in XSUBs.
The PADLIST has a C array where pads are stored.
The 0th entry of the PADLIST is a PADNAMELIST which represents the ``names'' or rather the ``static type information'' for lexicals. The individual elements of a PADNAMELIST are PADNAMEs. Future refactorings might stop the PADNAMELIST from being stored in the PADLIST's array, so don't rely on it. See ``PadlistNAMES''.
The CvDEPTH'th entry of a PADLIST is a PAD (an AV) which is the stack frame at that depth of recursion into the CV. The 0th slot of a frame AV is an AV which is @_. Other entries are storage for variables and op targets.
Iterating over the PADNAMELIST iterates over all possible pad items. Pad slots for targets (SVs_PADTMP) and GVs end up having &PL_padname_undef ``names'', while slots for constants have &PL_padname_const ``names'' (see pad_alloc()). That &PL_padname_undef and &PL_padname_const are used is an implementation detail subject to change. To test for them, use "!PadnamePV(name)" and "PadnamePV(name) && !PadnameLEN(name)", respectively.
Only my/our variable slots get valid names. The rest are op targets/GVs/constants which are statically allocated or resolved at compile time. These don't have names by which they can be looked up from Perl code at run time through eval"`` the way my/our variables can be. Since they can't be looked up by ''name" but only by their index allocated at compile time (which is usually in PL_op->op_targ), wasting a name SV for them doesn't make sense.
The pad names in the PADNAMELIST have their PV holding the name of the variable. The COP_SEQ_RANGE_LOW and _HIGH fields form a range (low+1..high inclusive) of cop_seq numbers for which the name is valid. During compilation, these fields may hold the special value PERL_PADSEQ_INTRO to indicate various stages:
COP_SEQ_RANGE_LOW _HIGH ----------------- ----- PERL_PADSEQ_INTRO 0 variable not yet introduced: { my ($x valid-seq# PERL_PADSEQ_INTRO variable in scope: { my ($x) valid-seq# valid-seq# compilation of scope complete: { my ($x) }
For typed lexicals PadnameTYPE points at the type stash. For "our" lexicals, PadnameOURSTASH points at the stash of the associated global (so that duplicate "our" declarations in the same package can be detected). PadnameGEN is sometimes used to store the generation number during compilation.
If PadnameOUTER is set on the pad name, then that slot in the frame AV is a REFCNT'ed reference to a lexical from ``outside''. Such entries are sometimes referred to as 'fake'. In this case, the name does not use 'low' and 'high' to store a cop_seq range, since it is in scope throughout. Instead 'high' stores some flags containing info about the real lexical (is it declared in an anon, and is it capable of being instantiated multiple times?), and for fake ANONs, 'low' contains the index within the parent's pad where the lexical's value is stored, to make cloning quicker.
If the 'name' is '&' the corresponding entry in the PAD is a CV representing a possible closure.
Note that formats are treated as anon subs, and are cloned each time write is called (if necessary).
The flag SVs_PADSTALE is cleared on lexicals each time the my() is executed, and set on scope exit. This allows the 'Variable $x is not available' warning to be generated in evals, such as
{ my $x = 1; sub f { eval '$x'} } f();
For state vars, SVs_PADSTALE is overloaded to mean 'not yet initialised', but this internal state is stored in a separate pad entry.
PADLIST * CvPADLIST(CV *cv)
- PadARRAY
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The C array of pad entries.
SV ** PadARRAY(PAD pad)
- PadlistARRAY
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The C array of a padlist, containing the pads. Only subscript it with numbers >= 1, as the 0th entry is not guaranteed to remain usable.
PAD ** PadlistARRAY(PADLIST padlist)
- PadlistMAX
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The index of the last allocated space in the padlist. Note that the last pad may be in an earlier slot. Any entries following it will be NULL in that case.
SSize_t PadlistMAX(PADLIST padlist)
- PadlistNAMES
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The names associated with pad entries.
PADNAMELIST * PadlistNAMES(PADLIST padlist)
- PadlistNAMESARRAY
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The C array of pad names.
PADNAME ** PadlistNAMESARRAY(PADLIST padlist)
- PadlistNAMESMAX
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The index of the last pad name.
SSize_t PadlistNAMESMAX(PADLIST padlist)
- PadlistREFCNT
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The reference count of the padlist. Currently this is always 1.
U32 PadlistREFCNT(PADLIST padlist)
- PadMAX
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The index of the last pad entry.
SSize_t PadMAX(PAD pad)
- PadnameLEN
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The length of the name.
STRLEN PadnameLEN(PADNAME pn)
- PadnamelistARRAY
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The C array of pad names.
PADNAME ** PadnamelistARRAY(PADNAMELIST pnl)
- PadnamelistMAX
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The index of the last pad name.
SSize_t PadnamelistMAX(PADNAMELIST pnl)
- PadnamelistREFCNT
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The reference count of the pad name list.
SSize_t PadnamelistREFCNT(PADNAMELIST pnl)
- PadnamelistREFCNT_dec
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Lowers the reference count of the pad name list.
void PadnamelistREFCNT_dec(PADNAMELIST pnl)
- PadnamePV
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The name stored in the pad name struct. This returns NULL for a target slot.
char * PadnamePV(PADNAME pn)
- PadnameREFCNT
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
The reference count of the pad name.
SSize_t PadnameREFCNT(PADNAME pn)
- PadnameREFCNT_dec
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Lowers the reference count of the pad name.
void PadnameREFCNT_dec(PADNAME pn)
- PadnameSV
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Returns the pad name as a mortal SV.
SV * PadnameSV(PADNAME pn)
- PadnameUTF8
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Whether PadnamePV is in UTF8. Currently, this is always true.
bool PadnameUTF8(PADNAME pn)
- pad_add_name_pvs
-
Exactly like ``pad_add_name_pvn'', but takes a literal string instead
of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_add_name_pvs(const char *name, U32 flags, HV *typestash, HV *ourstash)
- pad_findmy_pvs
-
Exactly like ``pad_findmy_pvn'', but takes a literal string instead
of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_findmy_pvs(const char *name, U32 flags)
- pad_new
-
Create a new padlist, updating the global variables for the
currently-compiling padlist to point to the new padlist. The following
flags can be OR'ed together:
padnew_CLONE this pad is for a cloned CV padnew_SAVE save old globals on the save stack padnew_SAVESUB also save extra stuff for start of sub PADLIST * pad_new(int flags)
- PL_comppad
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
During compilation, this points to the array containing the values part of the pad for the currently-compiling code. (At runtime a CV may have many such value arrays; at compile time just one is constructed.) At runtime, this points to the array containing the currently-relevant values for the pad for the currently-executing code.
- PL_comppad_name
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
During compilation, this points to the array containing the names part of the pad for the currently-compiling code.
- PL_curpad
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Points directly to the body of the ``PL_comppad'' array. (I.e., this is "PAD_ARRAY(PL_comppad)".)
Per-Interpreter Variables
- PL_modglobal
-
"PL_modglobal" is a general purpose, interpreter global HV for use by
extensions that need to keep information on a per-interpreter basis.
In a pinch, it can also be used as a symbol table for extensions
to share data among each other. It is a good idea to use keys
prefixed by the package name of the extension that owns the data.
HV* PL_modglobal
- PL_na
-
A convenience variable which is typically used with "SvPV" when one
doesn't care about the length of the string. It is usually more efficient
to either declare a local variable and use that instead or to use the
"SvPV_nolen" macro.
STRLEN PL_na
- PL_opfreehook
-
When non-"NULL", the function pointed by this variable will be called each time an OP is freed with the corresponding OP as the argument.
This allows extensions to free any extra attribute they have locally attached to an OP.
It is also assured to first fire for the parent OP and then for its kids.
When you replace this variable, it is considered a good practice to store the possibly previously installed hook and that you recall it inside your own.
Perl_ophook_t PL_opfreehook
- PL_peepp
-
Pointer to the per-subroutine peephole optimiser. This is a function
that gets called at the end of compilation of a Perl subroutine (or
equivalently independent piece of Perl code) to perform fixups of
some ops and to perform small-scale optimisations. The function is
called once for each subroutine that is compiled, and is passed, as sole
parameter, a pointer to the op that is the entry point to the subroutine.
It modifies the op tree in place.
The peephole optimiser should never be completely replaced. Rather, add code to it by wrapping the existing optimiser. The basic way to do this can be seen in ``Compile pass 3: peephole optimization'' in perlguts. If the new code wishes to operate on ops throughout the subroutine's structure, rather than just at the top level, it is likely to be more convenient to wrap the ``PL_rpeepp'' hook.
peep_t PL_peepp
- PL_rpeepp
-
Pointer to the recursive peephole optimiser. This is a function
that gets called at the end of compilation of a Perl subroutine (or
equivalently independent piece of Perl code) to perform fixups of some
ops and to perform small-scale optimisations. The function is called
once for each chain of ops linked through their "op_next" fields;
it is recursively called to handle each side chain. It is passed, as
sole parameter, a pointer to the op that is at the head of the chain.
It modifies the op tree in place.
The peephole optimiser should never be completely replaced. Rather, add code to it by wrapping the existing optimiser. The basic way to do this can be seen in ``Compile pass 3: peephole optimization'' in perlguts. If the new code wishes to operate only on ops at a subroutine's top level, rather than throughout the structure, it is likely to be more convenient to wrap the ``PL_peepp'' hook.
peep_t PL_rpeepp
- PL_sv_no
-
This is the "false" SV. See "PL_sv_yes". Always refer to this as
&PL_sv_no.
SV PL_sv_no
- PL_sv_undef
-
This is the "undef" SV. Always refer to this as &PL_sv_undef.
SV PL_sv_undef
- PL_sv_yes
-
This is the "true" SV. See "PL_sv_no". Always refer to this as
&PL_sv_yes.
SV PL_sv_yes
REGEXP Functions
- SvRX
-
Convenience macro to get the REGEXP from a SV. This is approximately
equivalent to the following snippet:
if (SvMAGICAL(sv)) mg_get(sv); if (SvROK(sv)) sv = MUTABLE_SV(SvRV(sv)); if (SvTYPE(sv) == SVt_REGEXP) return (REGEXP*) sv;
NULL will be returned if a REGEXP* is not found.
REGEXP * SvRX(SV *sv)
- SvRXOK
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV (or the one it references)
is a REGEXP.
If you want to do something with the REGEXP* later use SvRX instead and check for NULL.
bool SvRXOK(SV* sv)
Stack Manipulation Macros
- dMARK
-
Declare a stack marker variable, "mark", for the XSUB. See "MARK" and
"dORIGMARK".
dMARK;
- dORIGMARK
-
Saves the original stack mark for the XSUB. See "ORIGMARK".
dORIGMARK;
- dSP
-
Declares a local copy of perl's stack pointer for the XSUB, available via
the "SP" macro. See "SP".
dSP;
- EXTEND
-
Used to extend the argument stack for an XSUB's return values. Once
used, guarantees that there is room for at least "nitems" to be pushed
onto the stack.
void EXTEND(SP, SSize_t nitems)
- MARK
- Stack marker variable for the XSUB. See "dMARK".
- mPUSHi
-
Push an integer onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element.
Does not use "TARG". See also "PUSHi", "mXPUSHi" and "XPUSHi".
void mPUSHi(IV iv)
- mPUSHn
-
Push a double onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element.
Does not use "TARG". See also "PUSHn", "mXPUSHn" and "XPUSHn".
void mPUSHn(NV nv)
- mPUSHp
-
Push a string onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element.
The "len" indicates the length of the string. Does not use "TARG".
See also "PUSHp", "mXPUSHp" and "XPUSHp".
void mPUSHp(char* str, STRLEN len)
- mPUSHs
-
Push an SV onto the stack and mortalizes the SV. The stack must have room
for this element. Does not use "TARG". See also "PUSHs" and "mXPUSHs".
void mPUSHs(SV* sv)
- mPUSHu
-
Push an unsigned integer onto the stack. The stack must have room for this
element. Does not use "TARG". See also "PUSHu", "mXPUSHu" and "XPUSHu".
void mPUSHu(UV uv)
- mXPUSHi
-
Push an integer onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary.
Does not use "TARG". See also "XPUSHi", "mPUSHi" and "PUSHi".
void mXPUSHi(IV iv)
- mXPUSHn
-
Push a double onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary.
Does not use "TARG". See also "XPUSHn", "mPUSHn" and "PUSHn".
void mXPUSHn(NV nv)
- mXPUSHp
-
Push a string onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. The "len"
indicates the length of the string. Does not use "TARG". See also "XPUSHp",
"mPUSHp" and "PUSHp".
void mXPUSHp(char* str, STRLEN len)
- mXPUSHs
-
Push an SV onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary and mortalizes
the SV. Does not use "TARG". See also "XPUSHs" and "mPUSHs".
void mXPUSHs(SV* sv)
- mXPUSHu
-
Push an unsigned integer onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary.
Does not use "TARG". See also "XPUSHu", "mPUSHu" and "PUSHu".
void mXPUSHu(UV uv)
- ORIGMARK
- The original stack mark for the XSUB. See "dORIGMARK".
- POPi
-
Pops an integer off the stack.
IV POPi
- POPl
-
Pops a long off the stack.
long POPl
- POPn
-
Pops a double off the stack.
NV POPn
- POPp
-
Pops a string off the stack.
char* POPp
- POPpbytex
-
Pops a string off the stack which must consist of bytes i.e. characters < 256.
char* POPpbytex
- POPpx
-
Pops a string off the stack. Identical to POPp. There are two names for
historical reasons.
char* POPpx
- POPs
-
Pops an SV off the stack.
SV* POPs
- PUSHi
-
Push an integer onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element.
Handles 'set' magic. Uses "TARG", so "dTARGET" or "dXSTARG" should be
called to declare it. Do not call multiple "TARG"-oriented macros to
return lists from XSUB's - see "mPUSHi" instead. See also "XPUSHi" and
"mXPUSHi".
void PUSHi(IV iv)
- PUSHMARK
-
Opening bracket for arguments on a callback. See "PUTBACK" and
perlcall.
void PUSHMARK(SP)
- PUSHmortal
-
Push a new mortal SV onto the stack. The stack must have room for this
element. Does not use "TARG". See also "PUSHs", "XPUSHmortal" and "XPUSHs".
void PUSHmortal()
- PUSHn
-
Push a double onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element.
Handles 'set' magic. Uses "TARG", so "dTARGET" or "dXSTARG" should be
called to declare it. Do not call multiple "TARG"-oriented macros to
return lists from XSUB's - see "mPUSHn" instead. See also "XPUSHn" and
"mXPUSHn".
void PUSHn(NV nv)
- PUSHp
-
Push a string onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element.
The "len" indicates the length of the string. Handles 'set' magic. Uses
"TARG", so "dTARGET" or "dXSTARG" should be called to declare it. Do not
call multiple "TARG"-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see
"mPUSHp" instead. See also "XPUSHp" and "mXPUSHp".
void PUSHp(char* str, STRLEN len)
- PUSHs
-
Push an SV onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element.
Does not handle 'set' magic. Does not use "TARG". See also "PUSHmortal",
"XPUSHs" and "XPUSHmortal".
void PUSHs(SV* sv)
- PUSHu
-
Push an unsigned integer onto the stack. The stack must have room for this
element. Handles 'set' magic. Uses "TARG", so "dTARGET" or "dXSTARG"
should be called to declare it. Do not call multiple "TARG"-oriented
macros to return lists from XSUB's - see "mPUSHu" instead. See also
"XPUSHu" and "mXPUSHu".
void PUSHu(UV uv)
- PUTBACK
-
Closing bracket for XSUB arguments. This is usually handled by "xsubpp".
See "PUSHMARK" and perlcall for other uses.
PUTBACK;
- SP
- Stack pointer. This is usually handled by "xsubpp". See "dSP" and "SPAGAIN".
- SPAGAIN
-
Refetch the stack pointer. Used after a callback. See perlcall.
SPAGAIN;
- XPUSHi
-
Push an integer onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Handles
'set' magic. Uses "TARG", so "dTARGET" or "dXSTARG" should be called to
declare it. Do not call multiple "TARG"-oriented macros to return lists
from XSUB's - see "mXPUSHi" instead. See also "PUSHi" and "mPUSHi".
void XPUSHi(IV iv)
- XPUSHmortal
-
Push a new mortal SV onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary.
Does not use "TARG". See also "XPUSHs", "PUSHmortal" and "PUSHs".
void XPUSHmortal()
- XPUSHn
-
Push a double onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Handles
'set' magic. Uses "TARG", so "dTARGET" or "dXSTARG" should be called to
declare it. Do not call multiple "TARG"-oriented macros to return lists
from XSUB's - see "mXPUSHn" instead. See also "PUSHn" and "mPUSHn".
void XPUSHn(NV nv)
- XPUSHp
-
Push a string onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. The "len"
indicates the length of the string. Handles 'set' magic. Uses "TARG", so
"dTARGET" or "dXSTARG" should be called to declare it. Do not call
multiple "TARG"-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see
"mXPUSHp" instead. See also "PUSHp" and "mPUSHp".
void XPUSHp(char* str, STRLEN len)
- XPUSHs
-
Push an SV onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Does not
handle 'set' magic. Does not use "TARG". See also "XPUSHmortal",
"PUSHs" and "PUSHmortal".
void XPUSHs(SV* sv)
- XPUSHu
-
Push an unsigned integer onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary.
Handles 'set' magic. Uses "TARG", so "dTARGET" or "dXSTARG" should be
called to declare it. Do not call multiple "TARG"-oriented macros to
return lists from XSUB's - see "mXPUSHu" instead. See also "PUSHu" and
"mPUSHu".
void XPUSHu(UV uv)
- XSRETURN
-
Return from XSUB, indicating number of items on the stack. This is usually
handled by "xsubpp".
void XSRETURN(int nitems)
- XSRETURN_EMPTY
-
Return an empty list from an XSUB immediately.
XSRETURN_EMPTY;
- XSRETURN_IV
-
Return an integer from an XSUB immediately. Uses "XST_mIV".
void XSRETURN_IV(IV iv)
- XSRETURN_NO
-
Return &PL_sv_no from an XSUB immediately. Uses "XST_mNO".
XSRETURN_NO;
- XSRETURN_NV
-
Return a double from an XSUB immediately. Uses "XST_mNV".
void XSRETURN_NV(NV nv)
- XSRETURN_PV
-
Return a copy of a string from an XSUB immediately. Uses "XST_mPV".
void XSRETURN_PV(char* str)
- XSRETURN_UNDEF
-
Return &PL_sv_undef from an XSUB immediately. Uses "XST_mUNDEF".
XSRETURN_UNDEF;
- XSRETURN_UV
-
Return an integer from an XSUB immediately. Uses "XST_mUV".
void XSRETURN_UV(IV uv)
- XSRETURN_YES
-
Return &PL_sv_yes from an XSUB immediately. Uses "XST_mYES".
XSRETURN_YES;
- XST_mIV
-
Place an integer into the specified position "pos" on the stack. The
value is stored in a new mortal SV.
void XST_mIV(int pos, IV iv)
- XST_mNO
-
Place &PL_sv_no into the specified position "pos" on the
stack.
void XST_mNO(int pos)
- XST_mNV
-
Place a double into the specified position "pos" on the stack. The value
is stored in a new mortal SV.
void XST_mNV(int pos, NV nv)
- XST_mPV
-
Place a copy of a string into the specified position "pos" on the stack.
The value is stored in a new mortal SV.
void XST_mPV(int pos, char* str)
- XST_mUNDEF
-
Place &PL_sv_undef into the specified position "pos" on the
stack.
void XST_mUNDEF(int pos)
- XST_mYES
-
Place &PL_sv_yes into the specified position "pos" on the
stack.
void XST_mYES(int pos)
SV Flags
- svtype
-
An enum of flags for Perl types. These are found in the file sv.h
in the "svtype" enum. Test these flags with the "SvTYPE" macro.
The types are:
SVt_NULL SVt_IV SVt_NV SVt_RV SVt_PV SVt_PVIV SVt_PVNV SVt_PVMG SVt_INVLIST SVt_REGEXP SVt_PVGV SVt_PVLV SVt_PVAV SVt_PVHV SVt_PVCV SVt_PVFM SVt_PVIO
These are most easily explained from the bottom up.
SVt_PVIO is for I/O objects, SVt_PVFM for formats, SVt_PVCV for subroutines, SVt_PVHV for hashes and SVt_PVAV for arrays.
All the others are scalar types, that is, things that can be bound to a "$" variable. For these, the internal types are mostly orthogonal to types in the Perl language.
Hence, checking "SvTYPE(sv) < SVt_PVAV" is the best way to see whether something is a scalar.
SVt_PVGV represents a typeglob. If !SvFAKE(sv), then it is a real, incoercible typeglob. If SvFAKE(sv), then it is a scalar to which a typeglob has been assigned. Assigning to it again will stop it from being a typeglob. SVt_PVLV represents a scalar that delegates to another scalar behind the scenes. It is used, e.g., for the return value of "substr" and for tied hash and array elements. It can hold any scalar value, including a typeglob. SVt_REGEXP is for regular expressions. SVt_INVLIST is for Perl core internal use only.
SVt_PVMG represents a ``normal'' scalar (not a typeglob, regular expression, or delegate). Since most scalars do not need all the internal fields of a PVMG, we save memory by allocating smaller structs when possible. All the other types are just simpler forms of SVt_PVMG, with fewer internal fields.
SVt_NULL can only hold undef. SVt_IV can hold undef, an integer, or a reference. (SVt_RV is an alias for SVt_IV, which exists for backward compatibility.) SVt_NV can hold any of those or a double. SVt_PV can only hold undef or a string. SVt_PVIV is a superset of SVt_PV and SVt_IV. SVt_PVNV is similar. SVt_PVMG can hold anything SVt_PVNV can hold, but it can, but does not have to, be blessed or magical. - SVt_INVLIST
- Type flag for scalars. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_IV
- Type flag for scalars. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_NULL
- Type flag for scalars. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_NV
- Type flag for scalars. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PV
- Type flag for scalars. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVAV
- Type flag for arrays. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVCV
- Type flag for subroutines. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVFM
- Type flag for formats. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVGV
- Type flag for typeglobs. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVHV
- Type flag for hashes. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVIO
- Type flag for I/O objects. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVIV
- Type flag for scalars. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVLV
- Type flag for scalars. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVMG
- Type flag for scalars. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_PVNV
- Type flag for scalars. See ``svtype''.
- SVt_REGEXP
- Type flag for regular expressions. See ``svtype''.
SV Manipulation Functions
- boolSV
-
Returns a true SV if "b" is a true value, or a false SV if "b" is 0.
See also "PL_sv_yes" and "PL_sv_no".
SV * boolSV(bool b)
- croak_xs_usage
-
A specialised variant of "croak()" for emitting the usage message for xsubs
croak_xs_usage(cv, "eee_yow");
works out the package name and subroutine name from "cv", and then calls "croak()". Hence if "cv" is &ouch::awk, it would call "croak" as:
Perl_croak(aTHX_ "Usage: %"SVf"::%"SVf"(%s)", "ouch" "awk", "eee_yow"); void croak_xs_usage(const CV *const cv, const char *const params)
- get_sv
-
Returns the SV of the specified Perl scalar. "flags" are passed to
"gv_fetchpv". If "GV_ADD" is set and the
Perl variable does not exist then it will be created. If "flags" is zero
and the variable does not exist then NULL is returned.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* get_sv(const char *name, I32 flags)
- newRV_inc
-
Creates an RV wrapper for an SV. The reference count for the original SV is
incremented.
SV* newRV_inc(SV* sv)
- newSVpadname
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Creates a new SV containing the pad name.
SV* newSVpadname(PADNAME *pn)
- newSVpvn_utf8
-
Creates a new SV and copies a string (which may contain "NUL" ("\0")
characters) into it. If utf8 is true, calls
"SvUTF8_on" on the new SV. Implemented as a wrapper around "newSVpvn_flags".
SV* newSVpvn_utf8(NULLOK const char* s, STRLEN len, U32 utf8)
- SvCUR
-
Returns the length of the string which is in the SV. See "SvLEN".
STRLEN SvCUR(SV* sv)
- SvCUR_set
-
Set the current length of the string which is in the SV. See "SvCUR"
and "SvIV_set".
void SvCUR_set(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvEND
-
Returns a pointer to the spot just after the last character in
the string which is in the SV, where there is usually a trailing
"NUL" character (even though Perl scalars do not strictly require it).
See "SvCUR". Access the character as *(SvEND(sv)).
Warning: If "SvCUR" is equal to "SvLEN", then "SvEND" points to unallocated memory.
char* SvEND(SV* sv)
- SvGAMAGIC
-
Returns true if the SV has get magic or
overloading. If either is true then
the scalar is active data, and has the potential to return a new value every
time it is accessed. Hence you must be careful to
only read it once per user logical operation and work
with that returned value. If neither is true then
the scalar's value cannot change unless written to.
U32 SvGAMAGIC(SV* sv)
- SvGROW
-
Expands the character buffer in the SV so that it has room for the
indicated number of bytes (remember to reserve space for an extra trailing
"NUL" character). Calls "sv_grow" to perform the expansion if necessary.
Returns a pointer to the character
buffer. SV must be of type >= SVt_PV. One
alternative is to call "sv_grow" if you are not sure of the type of SV.
char * SvGROW(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvIOK
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains an integer.
U32 SvIOK(SV* sv)
- SvIOKp
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains an integer. Checks
the private setting. Use "SvIOK" instead.
U32 SvIOKp(SV* sv)
- SvIOK_notUV
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV contains a signed integer.
bool SvIOK_notUV(SV* sv)
- SvIOK_off
-
Unsets the IV status of an SV.
void SvIOK_off(SV* sv)
- SvIOK_on
-
Tells an SV that it is an integer.
void SvIOK_on(SV* sv)
- SvIOK_only
-
Tells an SV that it is an integer and disables all other OK bits.
void SvIOK_only(SV* sv)
- SvIOK_only_UV
-
Tells an SV that it is an unsigned integer and disables all other OK bits.
void SvIOK_only_UV(SV* sv)
- SvIOK_UV
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV contains an integer that must be
interpreted as unsigned. A non-negative integer whose value is within the
range of both an IV and a UV may be be flagged as either SvUOK or SVIOK.
bool SvIOK_UV(SV* sv)
- SvIsCOW
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV is Copy-On-Write (either shared
hash key scalars, or full Copy On Write scalars if 5.9.0 is configured for
COW).
U32 SvIsCOW(SV* sv)
- SvIsCOW_shared_hash
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV is Copy-On-Write shared hash key
scalar.
bool SvIsCOW_shared_hash(SV* sv)
- SvIV
-
Coerces the given SV to an integer and returns it. See "SvIVx" for a
version which guarantees to evaluate sv only once.
IV SvIV(SV* sv)
- SvIVX
-
Returns the raw value in the SV's IV slot, without checks or conversions.
Only use when you are sure SvIOK is true. See also "SvIV()".
IV SvIVX(SV* sv)
- SvIVx
-
Coerces the given SV to an integer and returns it.
Guarantees to evaluate "sv" only once. Only use
this if "sv" is an expression with side effects,
otherwise use the more efficient "SvIV".
IV SvIVx(SV* sv)
- SvIV_nomg
-
Like "SvIV" but doesn't process magic.
IV SvIV_nomg(SV* sv)
- SvIV_set
-
Set the value of the IV pointer in sv to val. It is possible to perform
the same function of this macro with an lvalue assignment to "SvIVX".
With future Perls, however, it will be more efficient to use
"SvIV_set" instead of the lvalue assignment to "SvIVX".
void SvIV_set(SV* sv, IV val)
- SvLEN
-
Returns the size of the string buffer in the SV, not including any part
attributable to "SvOOK". See "SvCUR".
STRLEN SvLEN(SV* sv)
- SvLEN_set
-
Set the size of the string buffer for the SV. See "/SvLEN".
void SvLEN_set(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvMAGIC_set
-
Set the value of the MAGIC pointer in sv to val. See "SvIV_set".
void SvMAGIC_set(SV* sv, MAGIC* val)
- SvNIOK
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a number, integer or
double.
U32 SvNIOK(SV* sv)
- SvNIOKp
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a number, integer or
double. Checks the private setting. Use "SvNIOK" instead.
U32 SvNIOKp(SV* sv)
- SvNIOK_off
-
Unsets the NV/IV status of an SV.
void SvNIOK_off(SV* sv)
- SvNOK
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a double.
U32 SvNOK(SV* sv)
- SvNOKp
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a double. Checks the
private setting. Use "SvNOK" instead.
U32 SvNOKp(SV* sv)
- SvNOK_off
-
Unsets the NV status of an SV.
void SvNOK_off(SV* sv)
- SvNOK_on
-
Tells an SV that it is a double.
void SvNOK_on(SV* sv)
- SvNOK_only
-
Tells an SV that it is a double and disables all other OK bits.
void SvNOK_only(SV* sv)
- SvNV
-
Coerce the given SV to a double and return it. See "SvNVx" for a version
which guarantees to evaluate sv only once.
NV SvNV(SV* sv)
- SvNVX
-
Returns the raw value in the SV's NV slot, without checks or conversions.
Only use when you are sure SvNOK is true. See also "SvNV()".
NV SvNVX(SV* sv)
- SvNVx
-
Coerces the given SV to a double and returns it.
Guarantees to evaluate "sv" only once. Only use
this if "sv" is an expression with side effects,
otherwise use the more efficient "SvNV".
NV SvNVx(SV* sv)
- SvNV_nomg
-
Like "SvNV" but doesn't process magic.
NV SvNV_nomg(SV* sv)
- SvNV_set
-
Set the value of the NV pointer in sv to val. See "SvIV_set".
void SvNV_set(SV* sv, NV val)
- SvOK
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the value is defined. This is
only meaningful for scalars.
U32 SvOK(SV* sv)
- SvOOK
-
Returns a U32 indicating whether the pointer to the string buffer is offset.
This hack is used internally to speed up removal of characters from the
beginning of a SvPV. When SvOOK is true, then the start of the
allocated string buffer is actually "SvOOK_offset()" bytes before SvPVX.
This offset used to be stored in SvIVX, but is now stored within the spare
part of the buffer.
U32 SvOOK(SV* sv)
- SvOOK_offset
-
Reads into len the offset from SvPVX back to the true start of the
allocated buffer, which will be non-zero if "sv_chop" has been used to
efficiently remove characters from start of the buffer. Implemented as a
macro, which takes the address of len, which must be of type "STRLEN".
Evaluates sv more than once. Sets len to 0 if "SvOOK(sv)" is false.
void SvOOK_offset(NN SV*sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPOK
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a character
string.
U32 SvPOK(SV* sv)
- SvPOKp
-
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a character string.
Checks the private setting. Use "SvPOK" instead.
U32 SvPOKp(SV* sv)
- SvPOK_off
-
Unsets the PV status of an SV.
void SvPOK_off(SV* sv)
- SvPOK_on
-
Tells an SV that it is a string.
void SvPOK_on(SV* sv)
- SvPOK_only
-
Tells an SV that it is a string and disables all other OK bits.
Will also turn off the UTF-8 status.
void SvPOK_only(SV* sv)
- SvPOK_only_UTF8
-
Tells an SV that it is a string and disables all other OK bits,
and leaves the UTF-8 status as it was.
void SvPOK_only_UTF8(SV* sv)
- SvPV
-
Returns a pointer to the string in the SV, or a stringified form of
the SV if the SV does not contain a string. The SV may cache the
stringified version becoming "SvPOK". Handles 'get' magic. The
"len" variable will be set to the length of the string (this is a macro, so
don't use &len). See also "SvPVx" for a version which guarantees to
evaluate sv only once.
Note that there is no guarantee that the return value of "SvPV()" is equal to "SvPVX(sv)", or that "SvPVX(sv)" contains valid data, or that successive calls to "SvPV(sv)" will return the same pointer value each time. This is due to the way that things like overloading and Copy-On-Write are handled. In these cases, the return value may point to a temporary buffer or similar. If you absolutely need the SvPVX field to be valid (for example, if you intend to write to it), then see ``SvPV_force''.
char* SvPV(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPVbyte
-
Like "SvPV", but converts sv to byte representation first if necessary.
char* SvPVbyte(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPVbytex
-
Like "SvPV", but converts sv to byte representation first if necessary.
Guarantees to evaluate sv only once; use the more efficient "SvPVbyte"
otherwise.
char* SvPVbytex(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPVbytex_force
-
Like "SvPV_force", but converts sv to byte representation first if necessary.
Guarantees to evaluate sv only once; use the more efficient "SvPVbyte_force"
otherwise.
char* SvPVbytex_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPVbyte_force
-
Like "SvPV_force", but converts sv to byte representation first if necessary.
char* SvPVbyte_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPVbyte_nolen
-
Like "SvPV_nolen", but converts sv to byte representation first if necessary.
char* SvPVbyte_nolen(SV* sv)
- SvPVutf8
-
Like "SvPV", but converts sv to utf8 first if necessary.
char* SvPVutf8(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPVutf8x
-
Like "SvPV", but converts sv to utf8 first if necessary.
Guarantees to evaluate sv only once; use the more efficient "SvPVutf8"
otherwise.
char* SvPVutf8x(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPVutf8x_force
-
Like "SvPV_force", but converts sv to utf8 first if necessary.
Guarantees to evaluate sv only once; use the more efficient "SvPVutf8_force"
otherwise.
char* SvPVutf8x_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPVutf8_force
-
Like "SvPV_force", but converts sv to utf8 first if necessary.
char* SvPVutf8_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPVutf8_nolen
-
Like "SvPV_nolen", but converts sv to utf8 first if necessary.
char* SvPVutf8_nolen(SV* sv)
- SvPVX
-
Returns a pointer to the physical string in the SV. The SV must contain a
string. Prior to 5.9.3 it is not safe
to execute this macro unless the SV's
type >= SVt_PV.
This is also used to store the name of an autoloaded subroutine in an XS AUTOLOAD routine. See ``Autoloading with XSUBs'' in perlguts.
char* SvPVX(SV* sv)
- SvPVx
-
A version of "SvPV" which guarantees to evaluate "sv" only once.
Only use this if "sv" is an expression with side effects, otherwise use the
more efficient "SvPV".
char* SvPVx(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPV_force
-
Like "SvPV" but will force the SV into containing a string ("SvPOK"), and
only a string ("SvPOK_only"), by hook or by crook. You need force if you are
going to update the "SvPVX" directly. Processes get magic.
Note that coercing an arbitrary scalar into a plain PV will potentially strip useful data from it. For example if the SV was "SvROK", then the referent will have its reference count decremented, and the SV itself may be converted to an "SvPOK" scalar with a string buffer containing a value such as "ARRAY(0x1234)".
char* SvPV_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPV_force_nomg
-
Like "SvPV_force", but doesn't process get magic.
char* SvPV_force_nomg(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPV_nolen
-
Like "SvPV" but doesn't set a length variable.
char* SvPV_nolen(SV* sv)
- SvPV_nomg
-
Like "SvPV" but doesn't process magic.
char* SvPV_nomg(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
- SvPV_nomg_nolen
-
Like "SvPV_nolen" but doesn't process magic.
char* SvPV_nomg_nolen(SV* sv)
- SvPV_set
-
This is probably not what you want to use, you probably wanted
``sv_usepvn_flags'' or ``sv_setpvn'' or ``sv_setpvs''.
Set the value of the PV pointer in "sv" to the Perl allocated "NUL"-terminated string "val". See also "SvIV_set".
Remember to free the previous PV buffer. There are many things to check. Beware that the existing pointer may be involved in copy-on-write or other mischief, so do "SvOOK_off(sv)" and use "sv_force_normal" or "SvPV_force" (or check the SvIsCOW flag) first to make sure this modification is safe. Then finally, if it is not a COW, call "SvPV_free" to free the previous PV buffer.
void SvPV_set(SV* sv, char* val)
- SvREFCNT
-
Returns the value of the object's reference count.
U32 SvREFCNT(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_dec
-
Decrements the reference count of the given SV. sv may be NULL.
void SvREFCNT_dec(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_dec_NN
-
Same as SvREFCNT_dec, but can only be used if you know sv
is not NULL. Since we don't have to check the NULLness, it's faster
and smaller.
void SvREFCNT_dec_NN(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_inc
-
Increments the reference count of the given SV, returning the SV.
All of the following SvREFCNT_inc* macros are optimized versions of SvREFCNT_inc, and can be replaced with SvREFCNT_inc.
SV* SvREFCNT_inc(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_inc_NN
-
Same as SvREFCNT_inc, but can only be used if you know sv
is not NULL. Since we don't have to check the NULLness, it's faster
and smaller.
SV* SvREFCNT_inc_NN(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_inc_simple
-
Same as SvREFCNT_inc, but can only be used with expressions without side
effects. Since we don't have to store a temporary value, it's faster.
SV* SvREFCNT_inc_simple(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_inc_simple_NN
-
Same as SvREFCNT_inc_simple, but can only be used if you know sv
is not NULL. Since we don't have to check the NULLness, it's faster
and smaller.
SV* SvREFCNT_inc_simple_NN(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_inc_simple_void
-
Same as SvREFCNT_inc_simple, but can only be used if you don't need the
return value. The macro doesn't need to return a meaningful value.
void SvREFCNT_inc_simple_void(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_inc_simple_void_NN
-
Same as SvREFCNT_inc, but can only be used if you don't need the return
value, and you know that sv is not NULL. The macro doesn't need
to return a meaningful value, or check for NULLness, so it's smaller
and faster.
void SvREFCNT_inc_simple_void_NN(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_inc_void
-
Same as SvREFCNT_inc, but can only be used if you don't need the
return value. The macro doesn't need to return a meaningful value.
void SvREFCNT_inc_void(SV* sv)
- SvREFCNT_inc_void_NN
-
Same as SvREFCNT_inc, but can only be used if you don't need the return
value, and you know that sv is not NULL. The macro doesn't need
to return a meaningful value, or check for NULLness, so it's smaller
and faster.
void SvREFCNT_inc_void_NN(SV* sv)
- SvROK
-
Tests if the SV is an RV.
U32 SvROK(SV* sv)
- SvROK_off
-
Unsets the RV status of an SV.
void SvROK_off(SV* sv)
- SvROK_on
-
Tells an SV that it is an RV.
void SvROK_on(SV* sv)
- SvRV
-
Dereferences an RV to return the SV.
SV* SvRV(SV* sv)
- SvRV_set
-
Set the value of the RV pointer in sv to val. See "SvIV_set".
void SvRV_set(SV* sv, SV* val)
- SvSTASH
-
Returns the stash of the SV.
HV* SvSTASH(SV* sv)
- SvSTASH_set
-
Set the value of the STASH pointer in sv to val. See "SvIV_set".
void SvSTASH_set(SV* sv, HV* val)
- SvTAINT
-
Taints an SV if tainting is enabled, and if some input to the current
expression is tainted---usually a variable, but possibly also implicit
inputs such as locale settings. "SvTAINT" propagates that taintedness to
the outputs of an expression in a pessimistic fashion; i.e., without paying
attention to precisely which outputs are influenced by which inputs.
void SvTAINT(SV* sv)
- SvTAINTED
-
Checks to see if an SV is tainted. Returns TRUE if it is, FALSE if
not.
bool SvTAINTED(SV* sv)
- SvTAINTED_off
-
Untaints an SV. Be very careful with this routine, as it short-circuits
some of Perl's fundamental security features. XS module authors should not
use this function unless they fully understand all the implications of
unconditionally untainting the value. Untainting should be done in the
standard perl fashion, via a carefully crafted regexp, rather than directly
untainting variables.
void SvTAINTED_off(SV* sv)
- SvTAINTED_on
-
Marks an SV as tainted if tainting is enabled.
void SvTAINTED_on(SV* sv)
- SvTRUE
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether Perl would evaluate the SV as true or
false. See SvOK() for a defined/undefined test. Handles 'get' magic
unless the scalar is already SvPOK, SvIOK or SvNOK (the public, not the
private flags).
bool SvTRUE(SV* sv)
- SvTRUE_nomg
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether Perl would evaluate the SV as true or
false. See SvOK() for a defined/undefined test. Does not handle 'get' magic.
bool SvTRUE_nomg(SV* sv)
- SvTYPE
-
Returns the type of the SV. See "svtype".
svtype SvTYPE(SV* sv)
- SvUOK
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV contains an integer that must be
interpreted as unsigned. A non-negative integer whose value is within the
range of both an IV and a UV may be be flagged as either SvUOK or SVIOK.
bool SvUOK(SV* sv)
- SvUPGRADE
-
Used to upgrade an SV to a more complex form. Uses "sv_upgrade" to
perform the upgrade if necessary. See "svtype".
void SvUPGRADE(SV* sv, svtype type)
- SvUTF8
-
Returns a U32 value indicating the UTF-8 status of an SV. If things are set-up
properly, this indicates whether or not the SV contains UTF-8 encoded data.
You should use this after a call to SvPV() or one of its variants, in
case any call to string overloading updates the internal flag.
If you want to take into account the bytes pragma, use "DO_UTF8" instead.
U32 SvUTF8(SV* sv)
- SvUTF8_off
-
Unsets the UTF-8 status of an SV (the data is not changed, just the flag).
Do not use frivolously.
void SvUTF8_off(SV *sv)
- SvUTF8_on
-
Turn on the UTF-8 status of an SV (the data is not changed, just the flag).
Do not use frivolously.
void SvUTF8_on(SV *sv)
- SvUV
-
Coerces the given SV to an unsigned integer and returns it. See "SvUVx"
for a version which guarantees to evaluate sv only once.
UV SvUV(SV* sv)
- SvUVX
-
Returns the raw value in the SV's UV slot, without checks or conversions.
Only use when you are sure SvIOK is true. See also "SvUV()".
UV SvUVX(SV* sv)
- SvUVx
-
Coerces the given SV to an unsigned integer and
returns it. Guarantees to evaluate "sv" only once. Only
use this if "sv" is an expression with side effects,
otherwise use the more efficient "SvUV".
UV SvUVx(SV* sv)
- SvUV_nomg
-
Like "SvUV" but doesn't process magic.
UV SvUV_nomg(SV* sv)
- SvUV_set
-
Set the value of the UV pointer in sv to val. See "SvIV_set".
void SvUV_set(SV* sv, UV val)
- SvVOK
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV contains a v-string.
bool SvVOK(SV* sv)
- sv_catpvn_nomg
-
Like "sv_catpvn" but doesn't process magic.
void sv_catpvn_nomg(SV* sv, const char* ptr, STRLEN len)
- sv_catpv_nomg
-
Like "sv_catpv" but doesn't process magic.
void sv_catpv_nomg(SV* sv, const char* ptr)
- sv_catsv_nomg
-
Like "sv_catsv" but doesn't process magic.
void sv_catsv_nomg(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
- sv_derived_from
-
Exactly like ``sv_derived_from_pv'', but doesn't take a "flags" parameter.
bool sv_derived_from(SV* sv, const char *const name)
- sv_derived_from_pv
-
Exactly like ``sv_derived_from_pvn'', but takes a nul-terminated string
instead of a string/length pair.
bool sv_derived_from_pv(SV* sv, const char *const name, U32 flags)
- sv_derived_from_pvn
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV is derived from the specified class
at the C level. To check derivation at the Perl level, call "isa()" as a
normal Perl method.
Currently, the only significant value for "flags" is SVf_UTF8.
bool sv_derived_from_pvn(SV* sv, const char *const name, const STRLEN len, U32 flags)
- sv_derived_from_sv
-
Exactly like ``sv_derived_from_pvn'', but takes the name string in the form
of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
bool sv_derived_from_sv(SV* sv, SV *namesv, U32 flags)
- sv_does
-
Like ``sv_does_pv'', but doesn't take a "flags" parameter.
bool sv_does(SV* sv, const char *const name)
- sv_does_pv
-
Like ``sv_does_sv'', but takes a nul-terminated string instead of an SV.
bool sv_does_pv(SV* sv, const char *const name, U32 flags)
- sv_does_pvn
-
Like ``sv_does_sv'', but takes a string/length pair instead of an SV.
bool sv_does_pvn(SV* sv, const char *const name, const STRLEN len, U32 flags)
- sv_does_sv
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV performs a specific, named role.
The SV can be a Perl object or the name of a Perl class.
bool sv_does_sv(SV* sv, SV* namesv, U32 flags)
- sv_report_used
-
Dump the contents of all SVs not yet freed (debugging aid).
void sv_report_used()
- sv_setsv_nomg
-
Like "sv_setsv" but doesn't process magic.
void sv_setsv_nomg(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
- sv_utf8_upgrade_nomg
-
Like sv_utf8_upgrade, but doesn't do magic on "sv".
STRLEN sv_utf8_upgrade_nomg(NN SV *sv)
SV-Body Allocation
- looks_like_number
-
Test if the content of an SV looks like a number (or is a number).
"Inf" and "Infinity" are treated as numbers (so will not issue a
non-numeric warning), even if your atof() doesn't grok them. Get-magic is
ignored.
I32 looks_like_number(SV *const sv)
- newRV_noinc
-
Creates an RV wrapper for an SV. The reference count for the original
SV is not incremented.
SV* newRV_noinc(SV *const tmpRef)
- newSV
-
Creates a new SV. A non-zero "len" parameter indicates the number of
bytes of preallocated string space the SV should have. An extra byte for a
trailing "NUL" is also reserved. (SvPOK is not set for the SV even if string
space is allocated.) The reference count for the new SV is set to 1.
In 5.9.3, newSV() replaces the older NEWSV() API, and drops the first parameter, x, a debug aid which allowed callers to identify themselves. This aid has been superseded by a new build option, PERL_MEM_LOG (see ``PERL_MEM_LOG'' in perlhacktips). The older API is still there for use in XS modules supporting older perls.
SV* newSV(const STRLEN len)
- newSVhek
-
Creates a new SV from the hash key structure. It will generate scalars that
point to the shared string table where possible. Returns a new (undefined)
SV if the hek is NULL.
SV* newSVhek(const HEK *const hek)
- newSViv
-
Creates a new SV and copies an integer into it. The reference count for the
SV is set to 1.
SV* newSViv(const IV i)
- newSVnv
-
Creates a new SV and copies a floating point value into it.
The reference count for the SV is set to 1.
SV* newSVnv(const NV n)
- newSVpv
-
Creates a new SV and copies a string (which may contain "NUL" ("\0")
characters) into it. The reference count for the
SV is set to 1. If "len" is zero, Perl will compute the length using
strlen(), (which means if you use this option, that "s" can't have embedded
"NUL" characters and has to have a terminating "NUL" byte).
For efficiency, consider using "newSVpvn" instead.
SV* newSVpv(const char *const s, const STRLEN len)
- newSVpvf
-
Creates a new SV and initializes it with the string formatted like
"sprintf".
SV* newSVpvf(const char *const pat, ...)
- newSVpvn
-
Creates a new SV and copies a string into it, which may contain "NUL" characters
("\0") and other binary data. The reference count for the SV is set to 1.
Note that if "len" is zero, Perl will create a zero length (Perl) string. You
are responsible for ensuring that the source buffer is at least
"len" bytes long. If the "buffer" argument is NULL the new SV will be
undefined.
SV* newSVpvn(const char *const s, const STRLEN len)
- newSVpvn_flags
-
Creates a new SV and copies a string (which may contain "NUL" ("\0")
characters) into it. The reference count for the
SV is set to 1. Note that if "len" is zero, Perl will create a zero length
string. You are responsible for ensuring that the source string is at least
"len" bytes long. If the "s" argument is NULL the new SV will be undefined.
Currently the only flag bits accepted are "SVf_UTF8" and "SVs_TEMP".
If "SVs_TEMP" is set, then "sv_2mortal()" is called on the result before
returning. If "SVf_UTF8" is set, "s"
is considered to be in UTF-8 and the
"SVf_UTF8" flag will be set on the new SV.
"newSVpvn_utf8()" is a convenience wrapper for this function, defined as
#define newSVpvn_utf8(s, len, u) \ newSVpvn_flags((s), (len), (u) ? SVf_UTF8 : 0) SV* newSVpvn_flags(const char *const s, const STRLEN len, const U32 flags)
- newSVpvn_share
-
Creates a new SV with its SvPVX_const pointing to a shared string in the string
table. If the string does not already exist in the table, it is
created first. Turns on the SvIsCOW flag (or READONLY
and FAKE in 5.16 and earlier). If the "hash" parameter
is non-zero, that value is used; otherwise the hash is computed.
The string's hash can later be retrieved from the SV
with the "SvSHARED_HASH()" macro. The idea here is
that as the string table is used for shared hash keys these strings will have
SvPVX_const == HeKEY and hash lookup will avoid string compare.
SV* newSVpvn_share(const char* s, I32 len, U32 hash)
- newSVpvs
-
Like "newSVpvn", but takes a literal "NUL"-terminated string instead of a
string/length pair.
SV* newSVpvs(const char* s)
- newSVpvs_flags
-
Like "newSVpvn_flags", but takes a literal "NUL"-terminated string instead of
a string/length pair.
SV* newSVpvs_flags(const char* s, U32 flags)
- newSVpvs_share
-
Like "newSVpvn_share", but takes a literal "NUL"-terminated string instead of
a string/length pair and omits the hash parameter.
SV* newSVpvs_share(const char* s)
- newSVpv_share
-
Like "newSVpvn_share", but takes a "NUL"-terminated string instead of a
string/length pair.
SV* newSVpv_share(const char* s, U32 hash)
- newSVrv
-
Creates a new SV for the existing RV, "rv", to point to. If "rv" is not an
RV then it will be upgraded to one. If "classname" is non-null then the new
SV will be blessed in the specified package. The new SV is returned and its
reference count is 1. The reference count 1 is owned by "rv".
SV* newSVrv(SV *const rv, const char *const classname)
- newSVsv
-
Creates a new SV which is an exact duplicate of the original SV.
(Uses "sv_setsv".)
SV* newSVsv(SV *const old)
- newSVuv
-
Creates a new SV and copies an unsigned integer into it.
The reference count for the SV is set to 1.
SV* newSVuv(const UV u)
- newSV_type
-
Creates a new SV, of the type specified. The reference count for the new SV
is set to 1.
SV* newSV_type(const svtype type)
- sv_2bool
-
This macro is only used by sv_true() or its macro equivalent, and only if
the latter's argument is neither SvPOK, SvIOK nor SvNOK.
It calls sv_2bool_flags with the SV_GMAGIC flag.
bool sv_2bool(SV *const sv)
- sv_2bool_flags
-
This function is only used by sv_true() and friends, and only if
the latter's argument is neither SvPOK, SvIOK nor SvNOK. If the flags
contain SV_GMAGIC, then it does an mg_get() first.
bool sv_2bool_flags(SV *sv, I32 flags)
- sv_2cv
-
Using various gambits, try to get a CV from an SV; in addition, try if
possible to set *st and *gvp to the stash and GV associated with it.
The flags in "lref" are passed to gv_fetchsv.
CV* sv_2cv(SV* sv, HV **const st, GV **const gvp, const I32 lref)
- sv_2io
-
Using various gambits, try to get an IO from an SV: the IO slot if its a
GV; or the recursive result if we're an RV; or the IO slot of the symbol
named after the PV if we're a string.
'Get' magic is ignored on the sv passed in, but will be called on "SvRV(sv)" if sv is an RV.
IO* sv_2io(SV *const sv)
- sv_2iv_flags
-
Return the integer value of an SV, doing any necessary string
conversion. If flags includes SV_GMAGIC, does an mg_get() first.
Normally used via the "SvIV(sv)" and "SvIVx(sv)" macros.
IV sv_2iv_flags(SV *const sv, const I32 flags)
- sv_2mortal
-
Marks an existing SV as mortal. The SV will be destroyed ``soon'', either
by an explicit call to FREETMPS, or by an implicit call at places such as
statement boundaries. SvTEMP() is turned on which means that the SV's
string buffer can be ``stolen'' if this SV is copied. See also "sv_newmortal"
and "sv_mortalcopy".
SV* sv_2mortal(SV *const sv)
- sv_2nv_flags
-
Return the num value of an SV, doing any necessary string or integer
conversion. If flags includes SV_GMAGIC, does an mg_get() first.
Normally used via the "SvNV(sv)" and "SvNVx(sv)" macros.
NV sv_2nv_flags(SV *const sv, const I32 flags)
- sv_2pvbyte
-
Return a pointer to the byte-encoded representation of the SV, and set *lp
to its length. May cause the SV to be downgraded from UTF-8 as a
side-effect.
Usually accessed via the "SvPVbyte" macro.
char* sv_2pvbyte(SV *sv, STRLEN *const lp)
- sv_2pvutf8
-
Return a pointer to the UTF-8-encoded representation of the SV, and set *lp
to its length. May cause the SV to be upgraded to UTF-8 as a side-effect.
Usually accessed via the "SvPVutf8" macro.
char* sv_2pvutf8(SV *sv, STRLEN *const lp)
- sv_2pv_flags
-
Returns a pointer to the string value of an SV, and sets *lp to its length.
If flags includes SV_GMAGIC, does an mg_get() first. Coerces sv to a
string if necessary. Normally invoked via the "SvPV_flags" macro.
"sv_2pv()" and "sv_2pv_nomg" usually end up here too.
char* sv_2pv_flags(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const lp, const I32 flags)
- sv_2uv_flags
-
Return the unsigned integer value of an SV, doing any necessary string
conversion. If flags includes SV_GMAGIC, does an mg_get() first.
Normally used via the "SvUV(sv)" and "SvUVx(sv)" macros.
UV sv_2uv_flags(SV *const sv, const I32 flags)
- sv_backoff
-
Remove any string offset. You should normally use the "SvOOK_off" macro
wrapper instead.
int sv_backoff(SV *const sv)
- sv_bless
-
Blesses an SV into a specified package. The SV must be an RV. The package
must be designated by its stash (see "gv_stashpv()"). The reference count
of the SV is unaffected.
SV* sv_bless(SV *const sv, HV *const stash)
- sv_catpv
-
Concatenates the "NUL"-terminated string onto the end of the string which is
in the SV.
If the SV has the UTF-8 status set, then the bytes appended should be
valid UTF-8. Handles 'get' magic, but not 'set' magic. See "sv_catpv_mg".
void sv_catpv(SV *const sv, const char* ptr)
- sv_catpvf
-
Processes its arguments like "sprintf" and appends the formatted
output to an SV. If the appended data contains ``wide'' characters
(including, but not limited to, SVs with a UTF-8 PV formatted with %s,
and characters >255 formatted with %c), the original SV might get
upgraded to UTF-8. Handles 'get' magic, but not 'set' magic. See
"sv_catpvf_mg". If the original SV was UTF-8, the pattern should be
valid UTF-8; if the original SV was bytes, the pattern should be too.
void sv_catpvf(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, ...)
- sv_catpvf_mg
-
Like "sv_catpvf", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_catpvf_mg(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, ...)
- sv_catpvn
-
Concatenates the string onto the end of the string which is in the SV. The
"len" indicates number of bytes to copy. If the SV has the UTF-8
status set, then the bytes appended should be valid UTF-8.
Handles 'get' magic, but not 'set' magic. See "sv_catpvn_mg".
void sv_catpvn(SV *dsv, const char *sstr, STRLEN len)
- sv_catpvn_flags
-
Concatenates the string onto the end of the string which is in the SV. The
"len" indicates number of bytes to copy.
By default, the string appended is assumed to be valid UTF-8 if the SV has the UTF-8 status set, and a string of bytes otherwise. One can force the appended string to be interpreted as UTF-8 by supplying the "SV_CATUTF8" flag, and as bytes by supplying the "SV_CATBYTES" flag; the SV or the string appended will be upgraded to UTF-8 if necessary.
If "flags" has the "SV_SMAGIC" bit set, will "mg_set" on "dsv" afterwards if appropriate. "sv_catpvn" and "sv_catpvn_nomg" are implemented in terms of this function.
void sv_catpvn_flags(SV *const dstr, const char *sstr, const STRLEN len, const I32 flags)
- sv_catpvs
-
Like "sv_catpvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void sv_catpvs(SV* sv, const char* s)
- sv_catpvs_flags
-
Like "sv_catpvn_flags", but takes a literal "NUL"-terminated string instead
of a string/length pair.
void sv_catpvs_flags(SV* sv, const char* s, I32 flags)
- sv_catpvs_mg
-
Like "sv_catpvn_mg", but takes a literal string instead of a
string/length pair.
void sv_catpvs_mg(SV* sv, const char* s)
- sv_catpvs_nomg
-
Like "sv_catpvn_nomg", but takes a literal string instead of a
string/length pair.
void sv_catpvs_nomg(SV* sv, const char* s)
- sv_catpv_flags
-
Concatenates the "NUL"-terminated string onto the end of the string which is
in the SV.
If the SV has the UTF-8 status set, then the bytes appended should
be valid UTF-8. If "flags" has the "SV_SMAGIC" bit set, will "mg_set"
on the modified SV if appropriate.
void sv_catpv_flags(SV *dstr, const char *sstr, const I32 flags)
- sv_catpv_mg
-
Like "sv_catpv", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_catpv_mg(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr)
- sv_catsv
-
Concatenates the string from SV "ssv" onto the end of the string in SV
"dsv". If "ssv" is null, does nothing; otherwise modifies only "dsv".
Handles 'get' magic on both SVs, but no 'set' magic. See "sv_catsv_mg" and
"sv_catsv_nomg".
void sv_catsv(SV *dstr, SV *sstr)
- sv_catsv_flags
-
Concatenates the string from SV "ssv" onto the end of the string in SV
"dsv". If "ssv" is null, does nothing; otherwise modifies only "dsv".
If "flags" include "SV_GMAGIC" bit set, will call "mg_get" on both SVs if
appropriate. If "flags" include "SV_SMAGIC", "mg_set" will be called on
the modified SV afterward, if appropriate. "sv_catsv", "sv_catsv_nomg",
and "sv_catsv_mg" are implemented in terms of this function.
void sv_catsv_flags(SV *const dsv, SV *const ssv, const I32 flags)
- sv_chop
-
Efficient removal of characters from the beginning of the string buffer.
SvPOK(sv), or at least SvPOKp(sv), must be true and the "ptr" must be a
pointer to somewhere inside the string buffer. The "ptr" becomes the first
character of the adjusted string. Uses the ``OOK hack''. On return, only
SvPOK(sv) and SvPOKp(sv) among the OK flags will be true.
Beware: after this function returns, "ptr" and SvPVX_const(sv) may no longer refer to the same chunk of data.
The unfortunate similarity of this function's name to that of Perl's "chop" operator is strictly coincidental. This function works from the left; "chop" works from the right.
void sv_chop(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr)
- sv_clear
-
Clear an SV: call any destructors, free up any memory used by the body,
and free the body itself. The SV's head is not freed, although
its type is set to all 1's so that it won't inadvertently be assumed
to be live during global destruction etc.
This function should only be called when REFCNT is zero. Most of the time
you'll want to call "sv_free()" (or its macro wrapper "SvREFCNT_dec")
instead.
void sv_clear(SV *const orig_sv)
- sv_cmp
-
Compares the strings in two SVs. Returns -1, 0, or 1 indicating whether the
string in "sv1" is less than, equal to, or greater than the string in
"sv2". Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes' aware, handles get magic, and will
coerce its args to strings if necessary. See also "sv_cmp_locale".
I32 sv_cmp(SV *const sv1, SV *const sv2)
- sv_cmp_flags
-
Compares the strings in two SVs. Returns -1, 0, or 1 indicating whether the
string in "sv1" is less than, equal to, or greater than the string in
"sv2". Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes' aware and will coerce its args to strings
if necessary. If the flags include SV_GMAGIC, it handles get magic. See
also "sv_cmp_locale_flags".
I32 sv_cmp_flags(SV *const sv1, SV *const sv2, const U32 flags)
- sv_cmp_locale
-
Compares the strings in two SVs in a locale-aware manner. Is UTF-8 and
'use bytes' aware, handles get magic, and will coerce its args to strings
if necessary. See also "sv_cmp".
I32 sv_cmp_locale(SV *const sv1, SV *const sv2)
- sv_cmp_locale_flags
-
Compares the strings in two SVs in a locale-aware manner. Is UTF-8 and
'use bytes' aware and will coerce its args to strings if necessary. If the
flags contain SV_GMAGIC, it handles get magic. See also "sv_cmp_flags".
I32 sv_cmp_locale_flags(SV *const sv1, SV *const sv2, const U32 flags)
- sv_collxfrm
-
This calls "sv_collxfrm_flags" with the SV_GMAGIC flag. See
"sv_collxfrm_flags".
char* sv_collxfrm(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const nxp)
- sv_collxfrm_flags
-
Add Collate Transform magic to an SV if it doesn't already have it. If the
flags contain SV_GMAGIC, it handles get-magic.
Any scalar variable may carry PERL_MAGIC_collxfrm magic that contains the scalar data of the variable, but transformed to such a format that a normal memory comparison can be used to compare the data according to the locale settings.
char* sv_collxfrm_flags(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const nxp, I32 const flags)
- sv_copypv_flags
-
Implementation of sv_copypv and sv_copypv_nomg. Calls get magic iff flags
include SV_GMAGIC.
void sv_copypv_flags(SV *const dsv, SV *const ssv, const I32 flags)
- sv_copypv_nomg
-
Like sv_copypv, but doesn't invoke get magic first.
void sv_copypv_nomg(SV *const dsv, SV *const ssv)
- sv_dec
-
Auto-decrement of the value in the SV, doing string to numeric conversion
if necessary. Handles 'get' magic and operator overloading.
void sv_dec(SV *const sv)
- sv_dec_nomg
-
Auto-decrement of the value in the SV, doing string to numeric conversion
if necessary. Handles operator overloading. Skips handling 'get' magic.
void sv_dec_nomg(SV *const sv)
- sv_eq
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the strings in the two SVs are
identical. Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes' aware, handles get magic, and will
coerce its args to strings if necessary.
I32 sv_eq(SV* sv1, SV* sv2)
- sv_eq_flags
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the strings in the two SVs are
identical. Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes' aware and coerces its args to strings
if necessary. If the flags include SV_GMAGIC, it handles get-magic, too.
I32 sv_eq_flags(SV* sv1, SV* sv2, const U32 flags)
- sv_force_normal_flags
-
Undo various types of fakery on an SV, where fakery means
``more than'' a string: if the PV is a shared string, make
a private copy; if we're a ref, stop refing; if we're a glob, downgrade to
an xpvmg; if we're a copy-on-write scalar, this is the on-write time when
we do the copy, and is also used locally; if this is a
vstring, drop the vstring magic. If "SV_COW_DROP_PV" is set
then a copy-on-write scalar drops its PV buffer (if any) and becomes
SvPOK_off rather than making a copy. (Used where this
scalar is about to be set to some other value.) In addition,
the "flags" parameter gets passed to "sv_unref_flags()"
when unreffing. "sv_force_normal" calls this function
with flags set to 0.
This function is expected to be used to signal to perl that this SV is about to be written to, and any extra book-keeping needs to be taken care of. Hence, it croaks on read-only values.
void sv_force_normal_flags(SV *const sv, const U32 flags)
- sv_free
-
Decrement an SV's reference count, and if it drops to zero, call
"sv_clear" to invoke destructors and free up any memory used by
the body; finally, deallocate the SV's head itself.
Normally called via a wrapper macro "SvREFCNT_dec".
void sv_free(SV *const sv)
- sv_gets
-
Get a line from the filehandle and store it into the SV, optionally
appending to the currently-stored string. If "append" is not 0, the
line is appended to the SV instead of overwriting it. "append" should
be set to the byte offset that the appended string should start at
in the SV (typically, "SvCUR(sv)" is a suitable choice).
char* sv_gets(SV *const sv, PerlIO *const fp, I32 append)
- sv_get_backrefs
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
If the sv is the target of a weak reference then it returns the back references structure associated with the sv; otherwise return NULL.
When returning a non-null result the type of the return is relevant. If it is an AV then the elements of the AV are the weak reference RVs which point at this item. If it is any other type then the item itself is the weak reference.
See also Perl_sv_add_backref(), Perl_sv_del_backref(), Perl_sv_kill_backrefs()
SV* sv_get_backrefs(SV *const sv)
- sv_grow
-
Expands the character buffer in the SV. If necessary, uses "sv_unref" and
upgrades the SV to "SVt_PV". Returns a pointer to the character buffer.
Use the "SvGROW" wrapper instead.
char* sv_grow(SV *const sv, STRLEN newlen)
- sv_inc
-
Auto-increment of the value in the SV, doing string to numeric conversion
if necessary. Handles 'get' magic and operator overloading.
void sv_inc(SV *const sv)
- sv_inc_nomg
-
Auto-increment of the value in the SV, doing string to numeric conversion
if necessary. Handles operator overloading. Skips handling 'get' magic.
void sv_inc_nomg(SV *const sv)
- sv_insert
-
Inserts a string at the specified offset/length within the SV. Similar to
the Perl substr() function. Handles get magic.
void sv_insert(SV *const bigstr, const STRLEN offset, const STRLEN len, const char *const little, const STRLEN littlelen)
- sv_insert_flags
-
Same as "sv_insert", but the extra "flags" are passed to the
"SvPV_force_flags" that applies to "bigstr".
void sv_insert_flags(SV *const bigstr, const STRLEN offset, const STRLEN len, const char *const little, const STRLEN littlelen, const U32 flags)
- sv_isa
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV is blessed into the specified
class. This does not check for subtypes; use "sv_derived_from" to verify
an inheritance relationship.
int sv_isa(SV* sv, const char *const name)
- sv_isobject
-
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV is an RV pointing to a blessed
object. If the SV is not an RV, or if the object is not blessed, then this
will return false.
int sv_isobject(SV* sv)
- sv_len
-
Returns the length of the string in the SV. Handles magic and type
coercion and sets the UTF8 flag appropriately. See also "SvCUR", which
gives raw access to the xpv_cur slot.
STRLEN sv_len(SV *const sv)
- sv_len_utf8
-
Returns the number of characters in the string in an SV, counting wide
UTF-8 bytes as a single character. Handles magic and type coercion.
STRLEN sv_len_utf8(SV *const sv)
- sv_magic
-
Adds magic to an SV. First upgrades "sv" to type "SVt_PVMG" if
necessary, then adds a new magic item of type "how" to the head of the
magic list.
See "sv_magicext" (which "sv_magic" now calls) for a description of the handling of the "name" and "namlen" arguments.
You need to use "sv_magicext" to add magic to SvREADONLY SVs and also to add more than one instance of the same 'how'.
void sv_magic(SV *const sv, SV *const obj, const int how, const char *const name, const I32 namlen)
- sv_magicext
-
Adds magic to an SV, upgrading it if necessary. Applies the
supplied vtable and returns a pointer to the magic added.
Note that "sv_magicext" will allow things that "sv_magic" will not. In particular, you can add magic to SvREADONLY SVs, and add more than one instance of the same 'how'.
If "namlen" is greater than zero then a "savepvn" copy of "name" is stored, if "namlen" is zero then "name" is stored as-is and - as another special case - if "(name && namlen == HEf_SVKEY)" then "name" is assumed to contain an "SV*" and is stored as-is with its REFCNT incremented.
(This is now used as a subroutine by "sv_magic".)
MAGIC * sv_magicext(SV *const sv, SV *const obj, const int how, const MGVTBL *const vtbl, const char *const name, const I32 namlen)
- sv_mortalcopy
-
Creates a new SV which is a copy of the original SV (using "sv_setsv").
The new SV is marked as mortal. It will be destroyed ``soon'', either by an
explicit call to FREETMPS, or by an implicit call at places such as
statement boundaries. See also "sv_newmortal" and "sv_2mortal".
SV* sv_mortalcopy(SV *const oldsv)
- sv_newmortal
-
Creates a new null SV which is mortal. The reference count of the SV is
set to 1. It will be destroyed ``soon'', either by an explicit call to
FREETMPS, or by an implicit call at places such as statement boundaries.
See also "sv_mortalcopy" and "sv_2mortal".
SV* sv_newmortal()
- sv_newref
-
Increment an SV's reference count. Use the "SvREFCNT_inc()" wrapper
instead.
SV* sv_newref(SV *const sv)
- sv_pos_b2u
-
Converts the value pointed to by offsetp from a count of bytes from the
start of the string, to a count of the equivalent number of UTF-8 chars.
Handles magic and type coercion.
Use "sv_pos_b2u_flags" in preference, which correctly handles strings longer than 2Gb.
void sv_pos_b2u(SV *const sv, I32 *const offsetp)
- sv_pos_b2u_flags
-
Converts the offset from a count of bytes from the start of the string, to
a count of the equivalent number of UTF-8 chars. Handles type coercion.
flags is passed to "SvPV_flags", and usually should be
"SV_GMAGIC|SV_CONST_RETURN" to handle magic.
STRLEN sv_pos_b2u_flags(SV *const sv, STRLEN const offset, U32 flags)
- sv_pos_u2b
-
Converts the value pointed to by offsetp from a count of UTF-8 chars from
the start of the string, to a count of the equivalent number of bytes; if
lenp is non-zero, it does the same to lenp, but this time starting from
the offset, rather than from the start of the string. Handles magic and
type coercion.
Use "sv_pos_u2b_flags" in preference, which correctly handles strings longer than 2Gb.
void sv_pos_u2b(SV *const sv, I32 *const offsetp, I32 *const lenp)
- sv_pos_u2b_flags
-
Converts the offset from a count of UTF-8 chars from
the start of the string, to a count of the equivalent number of bytes; if
lenp is non-zero, it does the same to lenp, but this time starting from
the offset, rather than from the start
of the string. Handles type coercion.
flags is passed to "SvPV_flags", and usually should be
"SV_GMAGIC|SV_CONST_RETURN" to handle magic.
STRLEN sv_pos_u2b_flags(SV *const sv, STRLEN uoffset, STRLEN *const lenp, U32 flags)
- sv_pvbyten_force
-
The backend for the "SvPVbytex_force" macro. Always use the macro
instead.
char* sv_pvbyten_force(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const lp)
- sv_pvn_force
-
Get a sensible string out of the SV somehow.
A private implementation of the "SvPV_force" macro for compilers which
can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
char* sv_pvn_force(SV* sv, STRLEN* lp)
- sv_pvn_force_flags
-
Get a sensible string out of the SV somehow.
If "flags" has "SV_GMAGIC" bit set, will "mg_get" on "sv" if
appropriate, else not. "sv_pvn_force" and "sv_pvn_force_nomg" are
implemented in terms of this function.
You normally want to use the various wrapper macros instead: see
"SvPV_force" and "SvPV_force_nomg"
char* sv_pvn_force_flags(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const lp, const I32 flags)
- sv_pvutf8n_force
-
The backend for the "SvPVutf8x_force" macro. Always use the macro
instead.
char* sv_pvutf8n_force(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const lp)
- sv_reftype
-
Returns a string describing what the SV is a reference to.
const char* sv_reftype(const SV *const sv, const int ob)
- sv_replace
-
Make the first argument a copy of the second, then delete the original.
The target SV physically takes over ownership of the body of the source SV
and inherits its flags; however, the target keeps any magic it owns,
and any magic in the source is discarded.
Note that this is a rather specialist SV copying operation; most of the
time you'll want to use "sv_setsv" or one of its many macro front-ends.
void sv_replace(SV *const sv, SV *const nsv)
- sv_reset
-
Underlying implementation for the "reset" Perl function.
Note that the perl-level function is vaguely deprecated.
void sv_reset(const char* s, HV *const stash)
- sv_rvweaken
-
Weaken a reference: set the "SvWEAKREF" flag on this RV; give the
referred-to SV "PERL_MAGIC_backref" magic if it hasn't already; and
push a back-reference to this RV onto the array of backreferences
associated with that magic. If the RV is magical, set magic will be
called after the RV is cleared.
SV* sv_rvweaken(SV *const sv)
- sv_setiv
-
Copies an integer into the given SV, upgrading first if necessary.
Does not handle 'set' magic. See also "sv_setiv_mg".
void sv_setiv(SV *const sv, const IV num)
- sv_setiv_mg
-
Like "sv_setiv", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setiv_mg(SV *const sv, const IV i)
- sv_setnv
-
Copies a double into the given SV, upgrading first if necessary.
Does not handle 'set' magic. See also "sv_setnv_mg".
void sv_setnv(SV *const sv, const NV num)
- sv_setnv_mg
-
Like "sv_setnv", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setnv_mg(SV *const sv, const NV num)
- sv_setpv
-
Copies a string into an SV. The string must be terminated with a "NUL"
character.
Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_setpv_mg".
void sv_setpv(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr)
- sv_setpvf
-
Works like "sv_catpvf" but copies the text into the SV instead of
appending it. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_setpvf_mg".
void sv_setpvf(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, ...)
- sv_setpvf_mg
-
Like "sv_setpvf", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setpvf_mg(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, ...)
- sv_setpviv
-
Copies an integer into the given SV, also updating its string value.
Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_setpviv_mg".
void sv_setpviv(SV *const sv, const IV num)
- sv_setpviv_mg
-
Like "sv_setpviv", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setpviv_mg(SV *const sv, const IV iv)
- sv_setpvn
-
Copies a string (possibly containing embedded "NUL" characters) into an SV.
The "len" parameter indicates the number of
bytes to be copied. If the "ptr" argument is NULL the SV will become
undefined. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_setpvn_mg".
void sv_setpvn(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr, const STRLEN len)
- sv_setpvn_mg
-
Like "sv_setpvn", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setpvn_mg(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr, const STRLEN len)
- sv_setpvs
-
Like "sv_setpvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void sv_setpvs(SV* sv, const char* s)
- sv_setpvs_mg
-
Like "sv_setpvn_mg", but takes a literal string instead of a
string/length pair.
void sv_setpvs_mg(SV* sv, const char* s)
- sv_setpv_mg
-
Like "sv_setpv", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setpv_mg(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr)
- sv_setref_iv
-
Copies an integer into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The "rv"
argument will be upgraded to an RV. That RV will be modified to point to
the new SV. The "classname" argument indicates the package for the
blessing. Set "classname" to "NULL" to avoid the blessing. The new SV
will have a reference count of 1, and the RV will be returned.
SV* sv_setref_iv(SV *const rv, const char *const classname, const IV iv)
- sv_setref_nv
-
Copies a double into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The "rv"
argument will be upgraded to an RV. That RV will be modified to point to
the new SV. The "classname" argument indicates the package for the
blessing. Set "classname" to "NULL" to avoid the blessing. The new SV
will have a reference count of 1, and the RV will be returned.
SV* sv_setref_nv(SV *const rv, const char *const classname, const NV nv)
- sv_setref_pv
-
Copies a pointer into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The "rv"
argument will be upgraded to an RV. That RV will be modified to point to
the new SV. If the "pv" argument is NULL then "PL_sv_undef" will be placed
into the SV. The "classname" argument indicates the package for the
blessing. Set "classname" to "NULL" to avoid the blessing. The new SV
will have a reference count of 1, and the RV will be returned.
Do not use with other Perl types such as HV, AV, SV, CV, because those objects will become corrupted by the pointer copy process.
Note that "sv_setref_pvn" copies the string while this copies the pointer.
SV* sv_setref_pv(SV *const rv, const char *const classname, void *const pv)
- sv_setref_pvn
-
Copies a string into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The length of the
string must be specified with "n". The "rv" argument will be upgraded to
an RV. That RV will be modified to point to the new SV. The "classname"
argument indicates the package for the blessing. Set "classname" to
"NULL" to avoid the blessing. The new SV will have a reference count
of 1, and the RV will be returned.
Note that "sv_setref_pv" copies the pointer while this copies the string.
SV* sv_setref_pvn(SV *const rv, const char *const classname, const char *const pv, const STRLEN n)
- sv_setref_pvs
-
Like "sv_setref_pvn", but takes a literal string instead of a
string/length pair.
SV * sv_setref_pvs(const char* s)
- sv_setref_uv
-
Copies an unsigned integer into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The "rv"
argument will be upgraded to an RV. That RV will be modified to point to
the new SV. The "classname" argument indicates the package for the
blessing. Set "classname" to "NULL" to avoid the blessing. The new SV
will have a reference count of 1, and the RV will be returned.
SV* sv_setref_uv(SV *const rv, const char *const classname, const UV uv)
- sv_setsv
-
Copies the contents of the source SV "ssv" into the destination SV
"dsv". The source SV may be destroyed if it is mortal, so don't use this
function if the source SV needs to be reused. Does not handle 'set' magic on
destination SV. Calls 'get' magic on source SV. Loosely speaking, it
performs a copy-by-value, obliterating any previous content of the
destination.
You probably want to use one of the assortment of wrappers, such as "SvSetSV", "SvSetSV_nosteal", "SvSetMagicSV" and "SvSetMagicSV_nosteal".
void sv_setsv(SV *dstr, SV *sstr)
- sv_setsv_flags
-
Copies the contents of the source SV "ssv" into the destination SV
"dsv". The source SV may be destroyed if it is mortal, so don't use this
function if the source SV needs to be reused. Does not handle 'set' magic.
Loosely speaking, it performs a copy-by-value, obliterating any previous
content of the destination.
If the "flags" parameter has the "SV_GMAGIC" bit set, will "mg_get" on
"ssv" if appropriate, else not. If the "flags"
parameter has the "SV_NOSTEAL" bit set then the
buffers of temps will not be stolen. <sv_setsv>
and "sv_setsv_nomg" are implemented in terms of this function.
You probably want to use one of the assortment of wrappers, such as "SvSetSV", "SvSetSV_nosteal", "SvSetMagicSV" and "SvSetMagicSV_nosteal".
This is the primary function for copying scalars, and most other copy-ish functions and macros use this underneath.
void sv_setsv_flags(SV *dstr, SV *sstr, const I32 flags)
- sv_setsv_mg
-
Like "sv_setsv", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setsv_mg(SV *const dstr, SV *const sstr)
- sv_setuv
-
Copies an unsigned integer into the given SV, upgrading first if necessary.
Does not handle 'set' magic. See also "sv_setuv_mg".
void sv_setuv(SV *const sv, const UV num)
- sv_setuv_mg
-
Like "sv_setuv", but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setuv_mg(SV *const sv, const UV u)
- sv_tainted
-
Test an SV for taintedness. Use "SvTAINTED" instead.
bool sv_tainted(SV *const sv)
- sv_true
-
Returns true if the SV has a true value by Perl's rules.
Use the "SvTRUE" macro instead, which may call "sv_true()" or may
instead use an in-line version.
I32 sv_true(SV *const sv)
- sv_unmagic
-
Removes all magic of type "type" from an SV.
int sv_unmagic(SV *const sv, const int type)
- sv_unmagicext
-
Removes all magic of type "type" with the specified "vtbl" from an SV.
int sv_unmagicext(SV *const sv, const int type, MGVTBL *vtbl)
- sv_unref_flags
-
Unsets the RV status of the SV, and decrements the reference count of
whatever was being referenced by the RV. This can almost be thought of
as a reversal of "newSVrv". The "cflags" argument can contain
"SV_IMMEDIATE_UNREF" to force the reference count to be decremented
(otherwise the decrementing is conditional on the reference count being
different from one or the reference being a readonly SV).
See "SvROK_off".
void sv_unref_flags(SV *const ref, const U32 flags)
- sv_untaint
-
Untaint an SV. Use "SvTAINTED_off" instead.
void sv_untaint(SV *const sv)
- sv_upgrade
-
Upgrade an SV to a more complex form. Generally adds a new body type to the
SV, then copies across as much information as possible from the old body.
It croaks if the SV is already in a more complex form than requested. You
generally want to use the "SvUPGRADE" macro wrapper, which checks the type
before calling "sv_upgrade", and hence does not croak. See also
"svtype".
void sv_upgrade(SV *const sv, svtype new_type)
- sv_usepvn_flags
-
Tells an SV to use "ptr" to find its string value. Normally the
string is stored inside the SV, but sv_usepvn allows the SV to use an
outside string. The "ptr" should point to memory that was allocated
by Newx. It must be
the start of a Newx-ed block of memory, and not a pointer to the
middle of it (beware of OOK and copy-on-write),
and not be from a non-Newx memory allocator like "malloc". The
string length, "len", must be supplied. By default this function
will "Renew" (i.e. realloc, move) the memory pointed to by "ptr",
so that pointer should not be freed or used by the programmer after
giving it to sv_usepvn, and neither should any pointers from ``behind''
that pointer (e.g. ptr + 1) be used.
If "flags" & SV_SMAGIC is true, will call SvSETMAGIC. If "flags" & SV_HAS_TRAILING_NUL is true, then "ptr[len]" must be "NUL", and the realloc will be skipped (i.e. the buffer is actually at least 1 byte longer than "len", and already meets the requirements for storing in "SvPVX").
void sv_usepvn_flags(SV *const sv, char* ptr, const STRLEN len, const U32 flags)
- sv_utf8_decode
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
If the PV of the SV is an octet sequence in UTF-8 and contains a multiple-byte character, the "SvUTF8" flag is turned on so that it looks like a character. If the PV contains only single-byte characters, the "SvUTF8" flag stays off. Scans PV for validity and returns false if the PV is invalid UTF-8.
bool sv_utf8_decode(SV *const sv)
- sv_utf8_downgrade
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Attempts to convert the PV of an SV from characters to bytes. If the PV contains a character that cannot fit in a byte, this conversion will fail; in this case, either returns false or, if "fail_ok" is not true, croaks.
This is not a general purpose Unicode to byte encoding interface: use the Encode extension for that.
bool sv_utf8_downgrade(SV *const sv, const bool fail_ok)
- sv_utf8_encode
-
Converts the PV of an SV to UTF-8, but then turns the "SvUTF8"
flag off so that it looks like octets again.
void sv_utf8_encode(SV *const sv)
- sv_utf8_upgrade
-
Converts the PV of an SV to its UTF-8-encoded form.
Forces the SV to string form if it is not already.
Will "mg_get" on "sv" if appropriate.
Always sets the SvUTF8 flag to avoid future validity checks even
if the whole string is the same in UTF-8 as not.
Returns the number of bytes in the converted string
This is not a general purpose byte encoding to Unicode interface: use the Encode extension for that.
STRLEN sv_utf8_upgrade(SV *sv)
- sv_utf8_upgrade_flags
-
Converts the PV of an SV to its UTF-8-encoded form.
Forces the SV to string form if it is not already.
Always sets the SvUTF8 flag to avoid future validity checks even
if all the bytes are invariant in UTF-8.
If "flags" has "SV_GMAGIC" bit set,
will "mg_get" on "sv" if appropriate, else not.
If "flags" has SV_FORCE_UTF8_UPGRADE set, this function assumes that the PV will expand when converted to UTF-8, and skips the extra work of checking for that. Typically this flag is used by a routine that has already parsed the string and found such characters, and passes this information on so that the work doesn't have to be repeated.
Returns the number of bytes in the converted string.
This is not a general purpose byte encoding to Unicode interface: use the Encode extension for that.
STRLEN sv_utf8_upgrade_flags(SV *const sv, const I32 flags)
- sv_utf8_upgrade_flags_grow
-
Like sv_utf8_upgrade_flags, but has an additional parameter "extra", which is
the number of unused bytes the string of 'sv' is guaranteed to have free after
it upon return. This allows the caller to reserve extra space that it intends
to fill, to avoid extra grows.
"sv_utf8_upgrade", "sv_utf8_upgrade_nomg", and "sv_utf8_upgrade_flags" are implemented in terms of this function.
Returns the number of bytes in the converted string (not including the spares).
STRLEN sv_utf8_upgrade_flags_grow(SV *const sv, const I32 flags, STRLEN extra)
- sv_utf8_upgrade_nomg
-
Like sv_utf8_upgrade, but doesn't do magic on "sv".
STRLEN sv_utf8_upgrade_nomg(SV *sv)
- sv_vcatpvf
-
Processes its arguments like "vsprintf" and appends the formatted output
to an SV. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_vcatpvf_mg".
Usually used via its frontend "sv_catpvf".
void sv_vcatpvf(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, va_list *const args)
- sv_vcatpvfn
-
void sv_vcatpvfn(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, const STRLEN patlen, va_list *const args, SV **const svargs, const I32 svmax, bool *const maybe_tainted)
- sv_vcatpvfn_flags
-
Processes its arguments like "vsprintf" and appends the formatted output
to an SV. Uses an array of SVs if the C style variable argument list is
missing (NULL). When running with taint checks enabled, indicates via
"maybe_tainted" if results are untrustworthy (often due to the use of
locales).
If called as "sv_vcatpvfn" or flags include "SV_GMAGIC", calls get magic.
Usually used via one of its frontends "sv_vcatpvf" and "sv_vcatpvf_mg".
void sv_vcatpvfn_flags(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, const STRLEN patlen, va_list *const args, SV **const svargs, const I32 svmax, bool *const maybe_tainted, const U32 flags)
- sv_vcatpvf_mg
-
Like "sv_vcatpvf", but also handles 'set' magic.
Usually used via its frontend "sv_catpvf_mg".
void sv_vcatpvf_mg(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, va_list *const args)
- sv_vsetpvf
-
Works like "sv_vcatpvf" but copies the text into the SV instead of
appending it. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_vsetpvf_mg".
Usually used via its frontend "sv_setpvf".
void sv_vsetpvf(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, va_list *const args)
- sv_vsetpvfn
-
Works like "sv_vcatpvfn" but copies the text into the SV instead of
appending it.
Usually used via one of its frontends "sv_vsetpvf" and "sv_vsetpvf_mg".
void sv_vsetpvfn(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, const STRLEN patlen, va_list *const args, SV **const svargs, const I32 svmax, bool *const maybe_tainted)
- sv_vsetpvf_mg
-
Like "sv_vsetpvf", but also handles 'set' magic.
Usually used via its frontend "sv_setpvf_mg".
void sv_vsetpvf_mg(SV *const sv, const char *const pat, va_list *const args)
Unicode Support
``Unicode Support'' in perlguts has an introduction to this API.See also ``Character classification'', and ``Character case changing''. Various functions outside this section also work specially with Unicode. Search for the string ``utf8'' in this document.
- bytes_cmp_utf8
-
Compares the sequence of characters (stored as octets) in "b", "blen" with the
sequence of characters (stored as UTF-8)
in "u", "ulen". Returns 0 if they are
equal, -1 or -2 if the first string is less than the second string, +1 or +2
if the first string is greater than the second string.
-1 or +1 is returned if the shorter string was identical to the start of the longer string. -2 or +2 is returned if there was a difference between characters within the strings.
int bytes_cmp_utf8(const U8 *b, STRLEN blen, const U8 *u, STRLEN ulen)
- bytes_from_utf8
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Converts a string "s" of length "len" from UTF-8 into native byte encoding. Unlike ``utf8_to_bytes'' but like ``bytes_to_utf8'', returns a pointer to the newly-created string, and updates "len" to contain the new length. Returns the original string if no conversion occurs, "len" is unchanged. Do nothing if "is_utf8" points to 0. Sets "is_utf8" to 0 if "s" is converted or consisted entirely of characters that are invariant in utf8 (i.e., US-ASCII on non-EBCDIC machines).
U8* bytes_from_utf8(const U8 *s, STRLEN *len, bool *is_utf8)
- bytes_to_utf8
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Converts a string "s" of length "len" bytes from the native encoding into UTF-8. Returns a pointer to the newly-created string, and sets "len" to reflect the new length in bytes.
A "NUL" character will be written after the end of the string.
If you want to convert to UTF-8 from encodings other than the native (Latin1 or EBCDIC), see ``sv_recode_to_utf8''().
U8* bytes_to_utf8(const U8 *s, STRLEN *len)
- DO_UTF8
-
Returns a bool giving whether or not the PV in "sv" is to be treated as being
encoded in UTF-8.
You should use this after a call to "SvPV()" or one of its variants, in case any call to string overloading updates the internal UTF-8 encoding flag.
bool DO_UTF8(SV* sv)
- foldEQ_utf8
-
Returns true if the leading portions of the strings "s1" and "s2" (either or both
of which may be in UTF-8) are the same case-insensitively; false otherwise.
How far into the strings to compare is determined by other input parameters.
If "u1" is true, the string "s1" is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode; otherwise it is assumed to be in native 8-bit encoding. Correspondingly for "u2" with respect to "s2".
If the byte length "l1" is non-zero, it says how far into "s1" to check for fold equality. In other words, "s1"+"l1" will be used as a goal to reach. The scan will not be considered to be a match unless the goal is reached, and scanning won't continue past that goal. Correspondingly for "l2" with respect to "s2".
If "pe1" is non-NULL and the pointer it points to is not NULL, that pointer is considered an end pointer to the position 1 byte past the maximum point in "s1" beyond which scanning will not continue under any circumstances. (This routine assumes that UTF-8 encoded input strings are not malformed; malformed input can cause it to read past "pe1"). This means that if both "l1" and "pe1" are specified, and "pe1" is less than "s1"+"l1", the match will never be successful because it can never get as far as its goal (and in fact is asserted against). Correspondingly for "pe2" with respect to "s2".
At least one of "s1" and "s2" must have a goal (at least one of "l1" and "l2" must be non-zero), and if both do, both have to be reached for a successful match. Also, if the fold of a character is multiple characters, all of them must be matched (see tr21 reference below for 'folding').
Upon a successful match, if "pe1" is non-NULL, it will be set to point to the beginning of the next character of "s1" beyond what was matched. Correspondingly for "pe2" and "s2".
For case-insensitiveness, the ``casefolding'' of Unicode is used instead of upper/lowercasing both the characters, see <http://www.unicode.org/unicode/reports/tr21/> (Case Mappings).
I32 foldEQ_utf8(const char *s1, char **pe1, UV l1, bool u1, const char *s2, char **pe2, UV l2, bool u2)
- isUTF8_CHAR
-
Returns the number of bytes beginning at "s" which form a legal UTF-8 (or
UTF-EBCDIC) encoded character, looking no further than "e - s" bytes into
"s". Returns 0 if the sequence starting at "s" through "e - 1" is not
well-formed UTF-8
Note that an INVARIANT character (i.e. ASCII on non-EBCDIC machines) is a valid UTF-8 character.
STRLEN isUTF8_CHAR(const U8 *s, const U8 *e)
- is_ascii_string
-
This is a misleadingly-named synonym for ``is_invariant_string''.
On ASCII-ish platforms, the name isn't misleading: the ASCII-range characters
are exactly the UTF-8 invariants. But EBCDIC machines have more invariants
than just the ASCII characters, so "is_invariant_string" is preferred.
bool is_ascii_string(const U8 *s, STRLEN len)
- is_invariant_string
-
Returns true iff the first "len" bytes of the string "s" are the same
regardless of the UTF-8 encoding of the string (or UTF-EBCDIC encoding on
EBCDIC machines). That is, if they are UTF-8 invariant. On ASCII-ish
machines, all the ASCII characters and only the ASCII characters fit this
definition. On EBCDIC machines, the ASCII-range characters are invariant, but
so also are the C1 controls and "\c?" (which isn't in the ASCII range on
EBCDIC).
If "len" is 0, it will be calculated using strlen(s), (which means if you use this option, that "s" can't have embedded "NUL" characters and has to have a terminating "NUL" byte).
See also ``is_utf8_string''(), ``is_utf8_string_loclen''(), and ``is_utf8_string_loc''().
bool is_invariant_string(const U8 *s, STRLEN len)
- is_utf8_string
-
Returns true if the first "len" bytes of string "s" form a valid
UTF-8 string, false otherwise. If "len" is 0, it will be calculated
using strlen(s) (which means if you use this option, that "s" can't have
embedded "NUL" characters and has to have a terminating "NUL" byte). Note
that all characters being ASCII constitute 'a valid UTF-8 string'.
See also ``is_invariant_string''(), ``is_utf8_string_loclen''(), and ``is_utf8_string_loc''().
bool is_utf8_string(const U8 *s, STRLEN len)
- is_utf8_string_loc
-
Like ``is_utf8_string'' but stores the location of the failure (in the
case of ``utf8ness failure'') or the location "s"+"len" (in the case of
``utf8ness success'') in the "ep".
See also ``is_utf8_string_loclen''() and ``is_utf8_string''().
bool is_utf8_string_loc(const U8 *s, STRLEN len, const U8 **ep)
- is_utf8_string_loclen
-
Like ``is_utf8_string''() but stores the location of the failure (in the
case of ``utf8ness failure'') or the location "s"+"len" (in the case of
``utf8ness success'') in the "ep", and the number of UTF-8
encoded characters in the "el".
See also ``is_utf8_string_loc''() and ``is_utf8_string''().
bool is_utf8_string_loclen(const U8 *s, STRLEN len, const U8 **ep, STRLEN *el)
- pv_uni_display
-
Build to the scalar "dsv" a displayable version of the string "spv",
length "len", the displayable version being at most "pvlim" bytes long
(if longer, the rest is truncated and ``...'' will be appended).
The "flags" argument can have UNI_DISPLAY_ISPRINT set to display isPRINT()able characters as themselves, UNI_DISPLAY_BACKSLASH to display the \\[nrfta\\] as the backslashed versions (like '\n') (UNI_DISPLAY_BACKSLASH is preferred over UNI_DISPLAY_ISPRINT for \\). UNI_DISPLAY_QQ (and its alias UNI_DISPLAY_REGEX) have both UNI_DISPLAY_BACKSLASH and UNI_DISPLAY_ISPRINT turned on.
The pointer to the PV of the "dsv" is returned.
See also ``sv_uni_display''.
char* pv_uni_display(SV *dsv, const U8 *spv, STRLEN len, STRLEN pvlim, UV flags)
- sv_cat_decode
-
The encoding is assumed to be an Encode object, the PV of the ssv is
assumed to be octets in that encoding and decoding the input starts
from the position which (PV + *offset) pointed to. The dsv will be
concatenated the decoded UTF-8 string from ssv. Decoding will terminate
when the string tstr appears in decoding output or the input ends on
the PV of the ssv. The value which the offset points will be modified
to the last input position on the ssv.
Returns TRUE if the terminator was found, else returns FALSE.
bool sv_cat_decode(SV* dsv, SV *encoding, SV *ssv, int *offset, char* tstr, int tlen)
- sv_recode_to_utf8
-
The encoding is assumed to be an Encode object, on entry the PV
of the sv is assumed to be octets in that encoding, and the sv
will be converted into Unicode (and UTF-8).
If the sv already is UTF-8 (or if it is not POK), or if the encoding is not a reference, nothing is done to the sv. If the encoding is not an "Encode::XS" Encoding object, bad things will happen. (See lib/encoding.pm and Encode.)
The PV of the sv is returned.
char* sv_recode_to_utf8(SV* sv, SV *encoding)
- sv_uni_display
-
Build to the scalar "dsv" a displayable version of the scalar "sv",
the displayable version being at most "pvlim" bytes long
(if longer, the rest is truncated and ``...'' will be appended).
The "flags" argument is as in ``pv_uni_display''().
The pointer to the PV of the "dsv" is returned.
char* sv_uni_display(SV *dsv, SV *ssv, STRLEN pvlim, UV flags)
- to_utf8_case
-
"p" contains the pointer to the UTF-8 string encoding
the character that is being converted. This routine assumes that the character
at "p" is well-formed.
"ustrp" is a pointer to the character buffer to put the conversion result to. "lenp" is a pointer to the length of the result.
"swashp" is a pointer to the swash to use.
Both the special and normal mappings are stored in lib/unicore/To/Foo.pl, and loaded by SWASHNEW, using lib/utf8_heavy.pl. "special" (usually, but not always, a multicharacter mapping), is tried first.
"special" is a string, normally "NULL" or "". "NULL" means to not use any special mappings; "" means to use the special mappings. Values other than these two are treated as the name of the hash containing the special mappings, like "utf8::ToSpecLower".
"normal" is a string like ``ToLower'' which means the swash %utf8::ToLower.
UV to_utf8_case(const U8 *p, U8* ustrp, STRLEN *lenp, SV **swashp, const char *normal, const char *special)
- to_utf8_fold
-
Instead use ``toFOLD_utf8''.
UV to_utf8_fold(const U8 *p, U8* ustrp, STRLEN *lenp)
- to_utf8_lower
-
Instead use ``toLOWER_utf8''.
UV to_utf8_lower(const U8 *p, U8* ustrp, STRLEN *lenp)
- to_utf8_title
-
Instead use ``toTITLE_utf8''.
UV to_utf8_title(const U8 *p, U8* ustrp, STRLEN *lenp)
- to_utf8_upper
-
Instead use ``toUPPER_utf8''.
UV to_utf8_upper(const U8 *p, U8* ustrp, STRLEN *lenp)
- utf8n_to_uvchr
-
THIS FUNCTION SHOULD BE USED IN ONLY VERY SPECIALIZED CIRCUMSTANCES.
Most code should use ``utf8_to_uvchr_buf''() rather than call this directly.
Bottom level UTF-8 decode routine. Returns the native code point value of the first character in the string "s", which is assumed to be in UTF-8 (or UTF-EBCDIC) encoding, and no longer than "curlen" bytes; *retlen (if "retlen" isn't NULL) will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
The value of "flags" determines the behavior when "s" does not point to a well-formed UTF-8 character. If "flags" is 0, when a malformation is found, zero is returned and *retlen is set so that ("s" + *retlen) is the next possible position in "s" that could begin a non-malformed character. Also, if UTF-8 warnings haven't been lexically disabled, a warning is raised.
Various ALLOW flags can be set in "flags" to allow (and not warn on) individual types of malformations, such as the sequence being overlong (that is, when there is a shorter sequence that can express the same code point; overlong sequences are expressly forbidden in the UTF-8 standard due to potential security issues). Another malformation example is the first byte of a character not being a legal first byte. See utf8.h for the list of such flags. For allowed 0 length strings, this function returns 0; for allowed overlong sequences, the computed code point is returned; for all other allowed malformations, the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER is returned, as these have no determinable reasonable value.
The UTF8_CHECK_ONLY flag overrides the behavior when a non-allowed (by other flags) malformation is found. If this flag is set, the routine assumes that the caller will raise a warning, and this function will silently just set "retlen" to "-1" (cast to "STRLEN") and return zero.
Note that this API requires disambiguation between successful decoding a "NUL" character, and an error return (unless the UTF8_CHECK_ONLY flag is set), as in both cases, 0 is returned. To disambiguate, upon a zero return, see if the first byte of "s" is 0 as well. If so, the input was a "NUL"; if not, the input had an error.
Certain code points are considered problematic. These are Unicode surrogates, Unicode non-characters, and code points above the Unicode maximum of 0x10FFFF. By default these are considered regular code points, but certain situations warrant special handling for them. If "flags" contains UTF8_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE, all three classes are treated as malformations and handled as such. The flags UTF8_DISALLOW_SURROGATE, UTF8_DISALLOW_NONCHAR, and UTF8_DISALLOW_SUPER (meaning above the legal Unicode maximum) can be set to disallow these categories individually.
The flags UTF8_WARN_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE, UTF8_WARN_SURROGATE, UTF8_WARN_NONCHAR, and UTF8_WARN_SUPER will cause warning messages to be raised for their respective categories, but otherwise the code points are considered valid (not malformations). To get a category to both be treated as a malformation and raise a warning, specify both the WARN and DISALLOW flags. (But note that warnings are not raised if lexically disabled nor if UTF8_CHECK_ONLY is also specified.)
Very large code points (above 0x7FFF_FFFF) are considered more problematic than the others that are above the Unicode legal maximum. There are several reasons: they requre at least 32 bits to represent them on ASCII platforms, are not representable at all on EBCDIC platforms, and the original UTF-8 specification never went above this number (the current 0x10FFFF limit was imposed later). (The smaller ones, those that fit into 32 bits, are representable by a UV on ASCII platforms, but not by an IV, which means that the number of operations that can be performed on them is quite restricted.) The UTF-8 encoding on ASCII platforms for these large code points begins with a byte containing 0xFE or 0xFF. The UTF8_DISALLOW_FE_FF flag will cause them to be treated as malformations, while allowing smaller above-Unicode code points. (Of course UTF8_DISALLOW_SUPER will treat all above-Unicode code points, including these, as malformations.) Similarly, UTF8_WARN_FE_FF acts just like the other WARN flags, but applies just to these code points.
All other code points corresponding to Unicode characters, including private use and those yet to be assigned, are never considered malformed and never warn.
UV utf8n_to_uvchr(const U8 *s, STRLEN curlen, STRLEN *retlen, U32 flags)
- utf8n_to_uvuni
-
Instead use ``utf8_to_uvchr_buf'', or rarely, ``utf8n_to_uvchr''.
This function was useful for code that wanted to handle both EBCDIC and ASCII platforms with Unicode properties, but starting in Perl v5.20, the distinctions between the platforms have mostly been made invisible to most code, so this function is quite unlikely to be what you want. If you do need this precise functionality, use instead "NATIVE_TO_UNI(utf8_to_uvchr_buf(...))" or "NATIVE_TO_UNI(utf8n_to_uvchr(...))".
UV utf8n_to_uvuni(const U8 *s, STRLEN curlen, STRLEN *retlen, U32 flags)
- UTF8SKIP
-
returns the number of bytes in the UTF-8 encoded character whose first (perhaps
only) byte is pointed to by "s".
STRLEN UTF8SKIP(char* s)
- utf8_distance
-
Returns the number of UTF-8 characters between the UTF-8 pointers "a"
and "b".
WARNING: use only if you *know* that the pointers point inside the same UTF-8 buffer.
IV utf8_distance(const U8 *a, const U8 *b)
- utf8_hop
-
Return the UTF-8 pointer "s" displaced by "off" characters, either
forward or backward.
WARNING: do not use the following unless you *know* "off" is within the UTF-8 data pointed to by "s" *and* that on entry "s" is aligned on the first byte of character or just after the last byte of a character.
U8* utf8_hop(const U8 *s, I32 off)
- utf8_length
-
Return the length of the UTF-8 char encoded string "s" in characters.
Stops at "e" (inclusive). If "e < s" or if the scan would end
up past "e", croaks.
STRLEN utf8_length(const U8* s, const U8 *e)
- utf8_to_bytes
-
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be
removed without notice.
Converts a string "s" of length "len" from UTF-8 into native byte encoding. Unlike ``bytes_to_utf8'', this over-writes the original string, and updates "len" to contain the new length. Returns zero on failure, setting "len" to -1.
If you need a copy of the string, see ``bytes_from_utf8''.
U8* utf8_to_bytes(U8 *s, STRLEN *len)
- utf8_to_uvchr_buf
-
Returns the native code point of the first character in the string "s" which
is assumed to be in UTF-8 encoding; "send" points to 1 beyond the end of "s".
*retlen will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
If "s" does not point to a well-formed UTF-8 character and UTF8 warnings are enabled, zero is returned and *retlen is set (if "retlen" isn't NULL) to -1. If those warnings are off, the computed value, if well-defined (or the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER if not), is silently returned, and *retlen is set (if "retlen" isn't NULL) so that ("s" + *retlen) is the next possible position in "s" that could begin a non-malformed character. See ``utf8n_to_uvchr'' for details on when the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER is returned.
UV utf8_to_uvchr_buf(const U8 *s, const U8 *send, STRLEN *retlen)
- utf8_to_uvuni_buf
-
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a
future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from
existing code.
Only in very rare circumstances should code need to be dealing in Unicode (as opposed to native) code points. In those few cases, use "NATIVE_TO_UNI(utf8_to_uvchr_buf(...))" instead.
Returns the Unicode (not-native) code point of the first character in the string "s" which is assumed to be in UTF-8 encoding; "send" points to 1 beyond the end of "s". "retlen" will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
If "s" does not point to a well-formed UTF-8 character and UTF8 warnings are enabled, zero is returned and *retlen is set (if "retlen" isn't NULL) to -1. If those warnings are off, the computed value if well-defined (or the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, if not) is silently returned, and *retlen is set (if "retlen" isn't NULL) so that ("s" + *retlen) is the next possible position in "s" that could begin a non-malformed character. See ``utf8n_to_uvchr'' for details on when the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER is returned.
UV utf8_to_uvuni_buf(const U8 *s, const U8 *send, STRLEN *retlen)
- UVCHR_SKIP
-
returns the number of bytes required to represent the code point "cp" when
encoded as UTF-8. "cp" is a native (ASCII or EBCDIC) code point if less than
255; a Unicode code point otherwise.
STRLEN UVCHR_SKIP(UV cp)
- uvchr_to_utf8
-
Adds the UTF-8 representation of the native code point "uv" to the end
of the string "d"; "d" should have at least "UVCHR_SKIP(uv)+1" (up to
"UTF8_MAXBYTES+1") free bytes available. The return value is the pointer to
the byte after the end of the new character. In other words,
d = uvchr_to_utf8(d, uv);
is the recommended wide native character-aware way of saying
*(d++) = uv;
This function accepts any UV as input. To forbid or warn on non-Unicode code points, or those that may be problematic, see ``uvchr_to_utf8_flags''.
U8* uvchr_to_utf8(U8 *d, UV uv)
- uvchr_to_utf8_flags
-
Adds the UTF-8 representation of the native code point "uv" to the end
of the string "d"; "d" should have at least "UVCHR_SKIP(uv)+1" (up to
"UTF8_MAXBYTES+1") free bytes available. The return value is the pointer to
the byte after the end of the new character. In other words,
d = uvchr_to_utf8_flags(d, uv, flags);
or, in most cases,
d = uvchr_to_utf8_flags(d, uv, 0);
This is the Unicode-aware way of saying
*(d++) = uv;
This function will convert to UTF-8 (and not warn) even code points that aren't legal Unicode or are problematic, unless "flags" contains one or more of the following flags:
If "uv" is a Unicode surrogate code point and UNICODE_WARN_SURROGATE is set, the function will raise a warning, provided UTF8 warnings are enabled. If instead UNICODE_DISALLOW_SURROGATE is set, the function will fail and return NULL. If both flags are set, the function will both warn and return NULL.
The UNICODE_WARN_NONCHAR and UNICODE_DISALLOW_NONCHAR flags affect how the function handles a Unicode non-character. And likewise, the UNICODE_WARN_SUPER and UNICODE_DISALLOW_SUPER flags affect the handling of code points that are above the Unicode maximum of 0x10FFFF. Code points above 0x7FFF_FFFF (which are even less portable) can be warned and/or disallowed even if other above-Unicode code points are accepted, by the UNICODE_WARN_FE_FF and UNICODE_DISALLOW_FE_FF flags.
And finally, the flag UNICODE_WARN_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE selects all four of the above WARN flags; and UNICODE_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE selects all four DISALLOW flags.
U8* uvchr_to_utf8_flags(U8 *d, UV uv, UV flags)
- uvoffuni_to_utf8_flags
-
THIS FUNCTION SHOULD BE USED IN ONLY VERY SPECIALIZED CIRCUMSTANCES.
Instead, Almost all code should use ``uvchr_to_utf8'' or
``uvchr_to_utf8_flags''.
This function is like them, but the input is a strict Unicode (as opposed to native) code point. Only in very rare circumstances should code not be using the native code point.
For details, see the description for ``uvchr_to_utf8_flags''.
U8* uvoffuni_to_utf8_flags(U8 *d, UV uv, UV flags)
- uvuni_to_utf8_flags
-
Instead you almost certainly want to use ``uvchr_to_utf8'' or
``uvchr_to_utf8_flags''.
This function is a deprecated synonym for ``uvoffuni_to_utf8_flags'', which itself, while not deprecated, should be used only in isolated circumstances. These functions were useful for code that wanted to handle both EBCDIC and ASCII platforms with Unicode properties, but starting in Perl v5.20, the distinctions between the platforms have mostly been made invisible to most code, so this function is quite unlikely to be what you want.
U8* uvuni_to_utf8_flags(U8 *d, UV uv, UV flags)
Variables created by xsubpp and xsubpp internal functions
- newXSproto
- Used by "xsubpp" to hook up XSUBs as Perl subs. Adds Perl prototypes to the subs.
- XS_APIVERSION_BOOTCHECK
-
Macro to verify that the perl api version an XS module has been compiled against
matches the api version of the perl interpreter it's being loaded into.
XS_APIVERSION_BOOTCHECK;
- XS_VERSION
- The version identifier for an XS module. This is usually handled automatically by "ExtUtils::MakeMaker". See "XS_VERSION_BOOTCHECK".
- XS_VERSION_BOOTCHECK
-
Macro to verify that a PM module's $VERSION variable matches the XS
module's "XS_VERSION" variable. This is usually handled automatically by
"xsubpp". See ``The VERSIONCHECK: Keyword'' in perlxs.
XS_VERSION_BOOTCHECK;
Versioning
- new_version
-
Returns a new version object based on the passed in SV:
SV *sv = new_version(SV *ver);
Does not alter the passed in ver SV. See ``upg_version'' if you want to upgrade the SV.
SV* new_version(SV *ver)
- prescan_version
-
Validate that a given string can be parsed as a version object, but doesn't
actually perform the parsing. Can use either strict or lax validation rules.
Can optionally set a number of hint variables to save the parsing code
some time when tokenizing.
const char* prescan_version(const char *s, bool strict, const char** errstr, bool *sqv, int *ssaw_decimal, int *swidth, bool *salpha)
- scan_version
-
Returns a pointer to the next character after the parsed
version string, as well as upgrading the passed in SV to
an RV.
Function must be called with an already existing SV like
sv = newSV(0); s = scan_version(s, SV *sv, bool qv);
Performs some preprocessing to the string to ensure that it has the correct characteristics of a version. Flags the object if it contains an underscore (which denotes this is an alpha version). The boolean qv denotes that the version should be interpreted as if it had multiple decimals, even if it doesn't.
const char* scan_version(const char *s, SV *rv, bool qv)
- upg_version
-
In-place upgrade of the supplied SV to a version object.
SV *sv = upg_version(SV *sv, bool qv);
Returns a pointer to the upgraded SV. Set the boolean qv if you want to force this SV to be interpreted as an ``extended'' version.
SV* upg_version(SV *ver, bool qv)
- vcmp
-
Version object aware cmp. Both operands must already have been
converted into version objects.
int vcmp(SV *lhv, SV *rhv)
- vnormal
-
Accepts a version object and returns the normalized string
representation. Call like:
sv = vnormal(rv);
NOTE: you can pass either the object directly or the SV contained within the RV.
The SV returned has a refcount of 1.
SV* vnormal(SV *vs)
- vnumify
-
Accepts a version object and returns the normalized floating
point representation. Call like:
sv = vnumify(rv);
NOTE: you can pass either the object directly or the SV contained within the RV.
The SV returned has a refcount of 1.
SV* vnumify(SV *vs)
- vstringify
-
In order to maintain maximum compatibility with earlier versions
of Perl, this function will return either the floating point
notation or the multiple dotted notation, depending on whether
the original version contained 1 or more dots, respectively.
The SV returned has a refcount of 1.
SV* vstringify(SV *vs)
- vverify
-
Validates that the SV contains valid internal structure for a version object.
It may be passed either the version object (RV) or the hash itself (HV). If
the structure is valid, it returns the HV. If the structure is invalid,
it returns NULL.
SV *hv = vverify(sv);
Note that it only confirms the bare minimum structure (so as not to get confused by derived classes which may contain additional hash entries):
SV* vverify(SV *vs)
Warning and Dieing
- croak
-
This is an XS interface to Perl's "die" function.
Take a sprintf-style format pattern and argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for ``mess_sv''.
The error message will be used as an exception, by default returning control to the nearest enclosing "eval", but subject to modification by a $SIG{__DIE__} handler. In any case, the "croak" function never returns normally.
For historical reasons, if "pat" is null then the contents of "ERRSV" ($@) will be used as an error message or object instead of building an error message from arguments. If you want to throw a non-string object, or build an error message in an SV yourself, it is preferable to use the ``croak_sv'' function, which does not involve clobbering "ERRSV".
void croak(const char *pat, ...)
- croak_no_modify
-
Exactly equivalent to "Perl_croak(aTHX_ "%s", PL_no_modify)", but generates
terser object code than using "Perl_croak". Less code used on exception code
paths reduces CPU cache pressure.
void croak_no_modify()
- croak_sv
-
This is an XS interface to Perl's "die" function.
"baseex" is the error message or object. If it is a reference, it will be used as-is. Otherwise it is used as a string, and if it does not end with a newline then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for ``mess_sv''.
The error message or object will be used as an exception, by default returning control to the nearest enclosing "eval", but subject to modification by a $SIG{__DIE__} handler. In any case, the "croak_sv" function never returns normally.
To die with a simple string message, the ``croak'' function may be more convenient.
void croak_sv(SV *baseex)
- die
-
Behaves the same as ``croak'', except for the return type.
It should be used only where the "OP *" return type is required.
The function never actually returns.
OP * die(const char *pat, ...)
- die_sv
-
Behaves the same as ``croak_sv'', except for the return type.
It should be used only where the "OP *" return type is required.
The function never actually returns.
OP * die_sv(SV *baseex)
- vcroak
-
This is an XS interface to Perl's "die" function.
"pat" and "args" are a sprintf-style format pattern and encapsulated argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for ``mess_sv''.
The error message will be used as an exception, by default returning control to the nearest enclosing "eval", but subject to modification by a $SIG{__DIE__} handler. In any case, the "croak" function never returns normally.
For historical reasons, if "pat" is null then the contents of "ERRSV" ($@) will be used as an error message or object instead of building an error message from arguments. If you want to throw a non-string object, or build an error message in an SV yourself, it is preferable to use the ``croak_sv'' function, which does not involve clobbering "ERRSV".
void vcroak(const char *pat, va_list *args)
- vwarn
-
This is an XS interface to Perl's "warn" function.
"pat" and "args" are a sprintf-style format pattern and encapsulated argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for ``mess_sv''.
The error message or object will by default be written to standard error, but this is subject to modification by a $SIG{__WARN__} handler.
Unlike with ``vcroak'', "pat" is not permitted to be null.
void vwarn(const char *pat, va_list *args)
- warn
-
This is an XS interface to Perl's "warn" function.
Take a sprintf-style format pattern and argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for ``mess_sv''.
The error message or object will by default be written to standard error, but this is subject to modification by a $SIG{__WARN__} handler.
Unlike with ``croak'', "pat" is not permitted to be null.
void warn(const char *pat, ...)
- warn_sv
-
This is an XS interface to Perl's "warn" function.
"baseex" is the error message or object. If it is a reference, it will be used as-is. Otherwise it is used as a string, and if it does not end with a newline then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for ``mess_sv''.
The error message or object will by default be written to standard error, but this is subject to modification by a $SIG{__WARN__} handler.
To warn with a simple string message, the ``warn'' function may be more convenient.
void warn_sv(SV *baseex)
Undocumented functions
The following functions have been flagged as part of the public API, but are currently undocumented. Use them at your own risk, as the interfaces are subject to change. Functions that are not listed in this document are not intended for public use, and should NOT be used under any circumstances.If you use one of the undocumented functions below, you may wish to consider creating and submitting documentation for it. If your patch is accepted, this will indicate that the interface is stable (unless it is explicitly marked otherwise).
- GetVars
- Gv_AMupdate
- PerlIO_clearerr
- PerlIO_close
- PerlIO_context_layers
- PerlIO_eof
- PerlIO_error
- PerlIO_fileno
- PerlIO_fill
- PerlIO_flush
- PerlIO_get_base
- PerlIO_get_bufsiz
- PerlIO_get_cnt
- PerlIO_get_ptr
- PerlIO_read
- PerlIO_seek
- PerlIO_set_cnt
- PerlIO_set_ptrcnt
- PerlIO_setlinebuf
- PerlIO_stderr
- PerlIO_stdin
- PerlIO_stdout
- PerlIO_tell
- PerlIO_unread
- PerlIO_write
- amagic_call
- amagic_deref_call
- any_dup
- atfork_lock
- atfork_unlock
- av_arylen_p
- av_iter_p
- block_gimme
- call_atexit
- call_list
- calloc
- cast_i32
- cast_iv
- cast_ulong
- cast_uv
- ck_warner
- ck_warner_d
- ckwarn
- ckwarn_d
- clone_params_del
- clone_params_new
- croak_memory_wrap
- croak_nocontext
- csighandler
- cx_dump
- cx_dup
- cxinc
- deb
- deb_nocontext
- debop
- debprofdump
- debstack
- debstackptrs
- delimcpy
- despatch_signals
- die_nocontext
- dirp_dup
- do_aspawn
- do_binmode
- do_close
- do_gv_dump
- do_gvgv_dump
- do_hv_dump
- do_join
- do_magic_dump
- do_op_dump
- do_open
- do_open9
- do_openn
- do_pmop_dump
- do_spawn
- do_spawn_nowait
- do_sprintf
- do_sv_dump
- doing_taint
- doref
- dounwind
- dowantarray
- dump_eval
- dump_form
- dump_indent
- dump_mstats
- dump_sub
- dump_vindent
- filter_add
- filter_del
- filter_read
- foldEQ_latin1
- form_nocontext
- fp_dup
- fprintf_nocontext
- free_global_struct
- free_tmps
- get_context
- get_mstats
- get_op_descs
- get_op_names
- get_ppaddr
- get_vtbl
- gp_dup
- gp_free
- gp_ref
- gv_AVadd
- gv_HVadd
- gv_IOadd
- gv_SVadd
- gv_add_by_type
- gv_autoload4
- gv_autoload_pv
- gv_autoload_pvn
- gv_autoload_sv
- gv_check
- gv_dump
- gv_efullname
- gv_efullname3
- gv_efullname4
- gv_fetchfile
- gv_fetchfile_flags
- gv_fetchpv
- gv_fetchpvn_flags
- gv_fetchsv
- gv_fullname
- gv_fullname3
- gv_fullname4
- gv_handler
- gv_name_set
- he_dup
- hek_dup
- hv_common
- hv_common_key_len
- hv_delayfree_ent
- hv_eiter_p
- hv_eiter_set
- hv_free_ent
- hv_ksplit
- hv_name_set
- hv_placeholders_get
- hv_placeholders_set
- hv_rand_set
- hv_riter_p
- hv_riter_set
- ibcmp_utf8
- init_global_struct
- init_stacks
- init_tm
- instr
- is_lvalue_sub
- leave_scope
- load_module_nocontext
- magic_dump
- malloc
- markstack_grow
- mess_nocontext
- mfree
- mg_dup
- mg_size
- mini_mktime
- moreswitches
- mro_get_from_name
- mro_get_private_data
- mro_set_mro
- mro_set_private_data
- my_atof
- my_atof2
- my_bcopy
- my_bzero
- my_chsize
- my_cxt_index
- my_cxt_init
- my_dirfd
- my_exit
- my_failure_exit
- my_fflush_all
- my_fork
- my_lstat
- my_memcmp
- my_memset
- my_pclose
- my_popen
- my_popen_list
- my_setenv
- my_socketpair
- my_stat
- my_strftime
- newANONATTRSUB
- newANONHASH
- newANONLIST
- newANONSUB
- newATTRSUB
- newAVREF
- newCVREF
- newFORM
- newGVREF
- newGVgen
- newGVgen_flags
- newHVREF
- newHVhv
- newIO
- newMYSUB
- newPROG
- newRV
- newSUB
- newSVREF
- newSVpvf_nocontext
- new_stackinfo
- ninstr
- op_refcnt_lock
- op_refcnt_unlock
- parser_dup
- perl_alloc_using
- perl_clone_using
- pmop_dump
- pop_scope
- pregcomp
- pregexec
- pregfree
- pregfree2
- printf_nocontext
- ptr_table_fetch
- ptr_table_free
- ptr_table_new
- ptr_table_split
- ptr_table_store
- push_scope
- re_compile
- re_dup_guts
- re_intuit_start
- re_intuit_string
- realloc
- reentrant_free
- reentrant_init
- reentrant_retry
- reentrant_size
- ref
- reg_named_buff_all
- reg_named_buff_exists
- reg_named_buff_fetch
- reg_named_buff_firstkey
- reg_named_buff_nextkey
- reg_named_buff_scalar
- regclass_swash
- regdump
- regdupe_internal
- regexec_flags
- regfree_internal
- reginitcolors
- regnext
- repeatcpy
- rninstr
- rsignal
- rsignal_state
- runops_debug
- runops_standard
- rvpv_dup
- safesyscalloc
- safesysfree
- safesysmalloc
- safesysrealloc
- save_I16
- save_I32
- save_I8
- save_adelete
- save_aelem
- save_aelem_flags
- save_alloc
- save_aptr
- save_ary
- save_bool
- save_clearsv
- save_delete
- save_destructor
- save_destructor_x
- save_freeop
- save_freepv
- save_freesv
- save_generic_pvref
- save_generic_svref
- save_gp
- save_hash
- save_hdelete
- save_helem
- save_helem_flags
- save_hints
- save_hptr
- save_int
- save_item
- save_iv
- save_list
- save_long
- save_mortalizesv
- save_nogv
- save_op
- save_padsv_and_mortalize
- save_pptr
- save_pushi32ptr
- save_pushptr
- save_pushptrptr
- save_re_context
- save_scalar
- save_set_svflags
- save_shared_pvref
- save_sptr
- save_svref
- save_vptr
- savestack_grow
- savestack_grow_cnt
- scan_num
- scan_vstring
- seed
- set_context
- set_numeric_local
- set_numeric_radix
- set_numeric_standard
- share_hek
- si_dup
- ss_dup
- stack_grow
- start_subparse
- str_to_version
- sv_2iv
- sv_2pv
- sv_2uv
- sv_catpvf_mg_nocontext
- sv_catpvf_nocontext
- sv_dup
- sv_dup_inc
- sv_peek
- sv_pvn_nomg
- sv_setpvf_mg_nocontext
- sv_setpvf_nocontext
- swash_fetch
- swash_init
- sys_init
- sys_init3
- sys_intern_clear
- sys_intern_dup
- sys_intern_init
- sys_term
- taint_env
- taint_proper
- unlnk
- unsharepvn
- utf16_to_utf8
- utf16_to_utf8_reversed
- uvuni_to_utf8
- vdeb
- vform
- vload_module
- vnewSVpvf
- vwarner
- warn_nocontext
- warner
- warner_nocontext
- whichsig
- whichsig_pv
- whichsig_pvn
- whichsig_sv
AUTHORS
Until May 1997, this document was maintained by Jeff Okamoto <[email protected]>. It is now maintained as part of Perl itself.With lots of help and suggestions from Dean Roehrich, Malcolm Beattie, Andreas Koenig, Paul Hudson, Ilya Zakharevich, Paul Marquess, Neil Bowers, Matthew Green, Tim Bunce, Spider Boardman, Ulrich Pfeifer, Stephen McCamant, and Gurusamy Sarathy.
API Listing originally by Dean Roehrich <[email protected]>.
Updated to be autogenerated from comments in the source by Benjamin Stuhl.